* target.h (struct thread_resume): Delete leave_stopped member.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger. Copyright (C)
2
3 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008,
4 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GDB.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include <stdio.h>
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
25 #include <ctype.h>
26 #include <stdarg.h>
27 #include "demangle.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
29 #include "frame.h"
30 #include "symtab.h"
31 #include "gdbtypes.h"
32 #include "gdbcmd.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
35 #include "language.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include "gdb_stat.h"
47 #ifdef UI_OUT
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #endif
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "infcall.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
54 #include "annotate.h"
55 #include "valprint.h"
56 #include "source.h"
57 #include "observer.h"
58 #include "vec.h"
59
60 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
61 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
62 Copied from valarith.c. */
63
64 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
65 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
66 #endif
67
68 static void extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf);
69
70 static void modify_general_field (char *, LONGEST, int, int);
71
72 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
73
74 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
75
76 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
77
78 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
79
80 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
81
82 static struct type *desc_data_type (struct type *);
83
84 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
85
86 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
87
88 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
89
90 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
91
92 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
93
94 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
95
96 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
97
98 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
99
100 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
101
102 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
103
104 static struct value *ensure_lval (struct value *, CORE_ADDR *);
105
106 static struct value *convert_actual (struct value *, struct type *,
107 CORE_ADDR *);
108
109 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *,
110 CORE_ADDR *);
111
112 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
113 struct block *, const char *,
114 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
115
116 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
117
118 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
119 struct block *);
120
121 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
122
123 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
124
125 static struct partial_symbol *ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab
126 *, const char *, int,
127 domain_enum, int);
128
129 static struct symtab *symtab_for_sym (struct symbol *);
130
131 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
132 struct type *);
133
134 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
135 struct symbol *, struct block *);
136
137 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
138
139 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
140
141 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
142
143 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
144
145 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
146
147 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
148
149 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
150
151 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
152 const char **,
153 int *,
154 const char **);
155
156 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
157 struct block *);
158
159 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
160 int, int, int *);
161
162 static struct value *evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
163 int *, enum noside);
164
165 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
166
167 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
168
169 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
170 const gdb_byte *,
171 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
172
173 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
174
175 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (char *, struct value *,
176 struct objfile *);
177
178 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
179 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
180
181 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
182
183 static struct type *packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
184
185 static struct type *decode_packed_array_type (struct type *);
186
187 static struct value *decode_packed_array (struct value *);
188
189 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
190 struct value **);
191
192 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int);
193
194 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
195 struct type *);
196
197 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
198
199 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
200
201 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
202
203 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
204
205 static int wild_match (const char *, int, const char *);
206
207 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
208
209 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
210
211 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
212
213 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
214
215 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
216 domain_enum);
217
218 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
219 struct type *);
220
221 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
222 struct type *);
223
224 static int find_struct_field (char *, struct type *, int,
225 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
226
227 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
228 struct value *);
229
230 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *);
231
232 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
233 struct value **, int, const char *,
234 struct type *);
235
236 static struct value *ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *);
237
238 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
239
240 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
241 struct language_arch_info *);
242
243 static void check_size (const struct type *);
244
245 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
246 struct type *);
247
248 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
249 struct expression *, int *, enum noside);
250
251 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
252 struct expression *,
253 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
254 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
255
256 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
257 struct expression *,
258 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
259 LONGEST, LONGEST);
260
261
262 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
263 struct expression *,
264 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
265
266
267 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
268
269
270 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
271 int *, enum noside);
272
273 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
274 int *);
275 \f
276
277
278 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
279 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
280
281 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
282 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
283 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
284 #ifdef VMS
285 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
286 #else
287 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
288 #endif
289
290 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
291 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
292 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
293
294 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
295 static int warning_limit = 2;
296
297 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
298 expression evaluation. */
299 static int warnings_issued = 0;
300
301 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
302 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
303 };
304
305 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
306 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
307 };
308
309 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
310 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
311
312 /* Utilities */
313
314 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
315 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
316 its unqualified name. */
317
318 static const char *
319 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
320 {
321 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
322
323 if (result != NULL)
324 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
325 else
326 result = decoded_name;
327
328 return result;
329 }
330
331 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
332 The result is good until the next call. */
333
334 static char *
335 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
336 {
337 static char *result = NULL;
338
339 xfree (result);
340 result = (char *) xmalloc ((strlen (str) + 3) * sizeof (char));
341
342 sprintf (result, "<%s>", str);
343 return result;
344 }
345
346 static char *
347 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
348 {
349 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
350 }
351
352 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
353
354 static void
355 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
356 const struct value_print_options *options)
357 {
358 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
359 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
360 }
361
362 /* Read the string located at ADDR from the inferior and store the
363 result into BUF. */
364
365 static void
366 extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf)
367 {
368 int char_index = 0;
369
370 /* Loop, reading one byte at a time, until we reach the '\000'
371 end-of-string marker. */
372 do
373 {
374 target_read_memory (addr + char_index * sizeof (char),
375 buf + char_index * sizeof (char), sizeof (char));
376 char_index++;
377 }
378 while (buf[char_index - 1] != '\000');
379 }
380
381 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
382 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
383 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
384
385 void *
386 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
387 {
388 if (*size < min_size)
389 {
390 *size *= 2;
391 if (*size < min_size)
392 *size = min_size;
393 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
394 }
395 return vect;
396 }
397
398 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
399 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
400
401 static int
402 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
403 {
404 int len = strlen (target);
405 return
406 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
407 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
408 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
409 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
410 "___XVN") != 0)));
411 }
412
413
414 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
415 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
416 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
417 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
418 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
419 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
420 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
421
422 int
423 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
424 int maybe_missing)
425 {
426 int fieldno;
427 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
428
429 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
430 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
431 return fieldno;
432
433 if (!maybe_missing)
434 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
435 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
436
437 return -1;
438 }
439
440 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
441
442 int
443 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
444 {
445 if (name == NULL)
446 return 0;
447 else
448 {
449 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
450 if (p == NULL)
451 return strlen (name);
452 else
453 return p - name;
454 }
455 }
456
457 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
458 Return zero if STR is null. */
459
460 static int
461 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
462 {
463 int len1, len2;
464 if (str == NULL)
465 return 0;
466 len1 = strlen (str);
467 len2 = strlen (suffix);
468 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
469 }
470
471 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
472 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
473
474 static struct value *
475 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
476 {
477 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
478 if (value_type (val) == type)
479 return val;
480 else
481 {
482 struct value *result;
483
484 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
485 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
486 check_size (type);
487
488 result = allocate_value (type);
489 set_value_component_location (result, val);
490 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
491 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
492 VALUE_ADDRESS (result) += value_offset (val);
493 if (value_lazy (val)
494 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
495 set_value_lazy (result, 1);
496 else
497 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
498 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
499 return result;
500 }
501 }
502
503 static const gdb_byte *
504 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
505 {
506 if (valaddr == NULL)
507 return NULL;
508 else
509 return valaddr + offset;
510 }
511
512 static CORE_ADDR
513 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
514 {
515 if (address == 0)
516 return 0;
517 else
518 return address + offset;
519 }
520
521 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
522 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
523 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
524 expression. */
525
526 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
527 provided by "complaint". */
528 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTR_FORMAT (printf, 1, 2);
529
530 static void
531 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
532 {
533 va_list args;
534 va_start (args, format);
535
536 warnings_issued += 1;
537 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
538 vwarning (format, args);
539
540 va_end (args);
541 }
542
543 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
544 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
545 GDB. */
546
547 static void
548 check_size (const struct type *type)
549 {
550 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
551 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
552 }
553
554
555 /* Note: would have used MAX_OF_TYPE and MIN_OF_TYPE macros from
556 gdbtypes.h, but some of the necessary definitions in that file
557 seem to have gone missing. */
558
559 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
560 static LONGEST
561 max_of_size (int size)
562 {
563 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
564 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
565 }
566
567 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
568 static LONGEST
569 min_of_size (int size)
570 {
571 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
572 }
573
574 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
575 static ULONGEST
576 umax_of_size (int size)
577 {
578 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
579 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
580 }
581
582 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
583 static LONGEST
584 max_of_type (struct type *t)
585 {
586 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
587 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
588 else
589 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
590 }
591
592 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
593 static LONGEST
594 min_of_type (struct type *t)
595 {
596 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
597 return 0;
598 else
599 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
600 }
601
602 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
603 static LONGEST
604 discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
605 {
606 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
607 {
608 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
609 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
610 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
611 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
612 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
613 return 1;
614 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
615 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
616 return max_of_type (type);
617 default:
618 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_high_bound."));
619 }
620 }
621
622 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
623 static LONGEST
624 discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
625 {
626 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
627 {
628 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
629 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
630 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
631 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 0);
632 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
633 return 0;
634 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
635 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
636 return min_of_type (type);
637 default:
638 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_low_bound."));
639 }
640 }
641
642 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
643 non-range scalar type. */
644
645 static struct type *
646 base_type (struct type *type)
647 {
648 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
649 {
650 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
651 return type;
652 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
653 }
654 return type;
655 }
656 \f
657
658 /* Language Selection */
659
660 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
661 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found).
662
663 MAIN_PST is not used. */
664
665 enum language
666 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang,
667 struct partial_symtab *main_pst)
668 {
669 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
670 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
671 return language_ada;
672
673 return lang;
674 }
675
676 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
677 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
678 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
679
680 char *
681 ada_main_name (void)
682 {
683 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
684 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
685 static char main_program_name[1024];
686
687 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
688 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
689 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
690 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
691 in Ada. */
692 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
693
694 if (msym != NULL)
695 {
696 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
697 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
698 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
699
700 extract_string (main_program_name_addr, main_program_name);
701 return main_program_name;
702 }
703
704 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
705 return NULL;
706 }
707 \f
708 /* Symbols */
709
710 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
711 of NULLs. */
712
713 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
714 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
715 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
716 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
717 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
718 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
719 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
720 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
721 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
722 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
723 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
724 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
725 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
726 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
727 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
728 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
729 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
730 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
731 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
732 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
733 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
734 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
735 {NULL, NULL}
736 };
737
738 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
739 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
740
741 char *
742 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
743 {
744 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
745 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
746 const char *p;
747 int k;
748
749 if (decoded == NULL)
750 return NULL;
751
752 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
753 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
754
755 k = 0;
756 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
757 {
758 if (*p == '.')
759 {
760 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
761 k += 2;
762 }
763 else if (*p == '"')
764 {
765 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
766
767 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
768 mapping->encoded != NULL
769 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
770 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
771 ;
772 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
773 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
774 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
775 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
776 break;
777 }
778 else
779 {
780 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
781 k += 1;
782 }
783 }
784
785 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
786 return encoding_buffer;
787 }
788
789 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
790 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
791 to next call. */
792
793 char *
794 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
795 {
796 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
797 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
798
799 int len = strlen (name);
800 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
801
802 if (name[0] == '\'')
803 {
804 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
805 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
806 }
807 else
808 {
809 int i;
810 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
811 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
812 }
813
814 return fold_buffer;
815 }
816
817 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
818
819 static int
820 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
821 {
822 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
823 }
824
825 /* Remove either of these suffixes:
826 . .{DIGIT}+
827 . ${DIGIT}+
828 . ___{DIGIT}+
829 . __{DIGIT}+.
830 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
831 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
832 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
833
834 static void
835 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
836 {
837 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
838 {
839 int i = *len - 2;
840 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
841 i--;
842 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
843 *len = i;
844 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
845 *len = i;
846 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
847 *len = i - 2;
848 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
849 *len = i - 1;
850 }
851 }
852
853 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
854 subprograms. */
855
856 static void
857 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
858 {
859 /* Remove trailing N. */
860
861 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
862 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
863 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
864 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
865 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
866 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
867 entity is internal. */
868
869 if (*len > 1
870 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
871 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
872 *len = *len - 1;
873 }
874
875 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
876 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
877 replaced by ENCODED.
878
879 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
880 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
881 is returned. */
882
883 const char *
884 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
885 {
886 int i, j;
887 int len0;
888 const char *p;
889 char *decoded;
890 int at_start_name;
891 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
892 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
893
894 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
895 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
896 if we see this prefix. */
897 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
898 encoded += 5;
899
900 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
901 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
902 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
903 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
904 goto Suppress;
905
906 len0 = strlen (encoded);
907
908 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
909 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
910
911 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
912 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
913 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
914 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
915 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
916 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
917 {
918 if (p[3] == 'X')
919 len0 = p - encoded;
920 else
921 goto Suppress;
922 }
923
924 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
925 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
926 appear in the decoded name. */
927
928 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
929 len0 -= 3;
930
931 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
932 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
933
934 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
935 len0 -= 1;
936
937 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
938
939 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
940 decoded = decoding_buffer;
941
942 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
943
944 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
945 {
946 i = len0 - 2;
947 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
948 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
949 i -= 1;
950 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
951 len0 = i - 1;
952 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
953 len0 = i;
954 }
955
956 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
957 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
958
959 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
960 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
961
962 at_start_name = 1;
963 while (i < len0)
964 {
965 /* Is this a symbol function? */
966 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
967 {
968 int k;
969 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
970 {
971 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
972 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
973 op_len - 1) == 0)
974 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
975 {
976 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
977 at_start_name = 0;
978 i += op_len;
979 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
980 break;
981 }
982 }
983 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
984 continue;
985 }
986 at_start_name = 0;
987
988 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
989 into "." (just below). */
990
991 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
992 i += 2;
993
994 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
995 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
996 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
997
998 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
999 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1000 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1001 {
1002 int k = i + 5;
1003
1004 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1005 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1006
1007 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1008 is indeed followed by "__". */
1009 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1010 i = k;
1011 }
1012
1013 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1014
1015 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1016 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1017 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1018 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1019 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1020 by a 'B'.
1021
1022 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1023 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1024 internally generated. */
1025
1026 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1027 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1028 {
1029 int k = i + 3;
1030
1031 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1032 k++;
1033
1034 if (k < len0
1035 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1036 {
1037 k++;
1038 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1039 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1040 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1041 if (k == len0
1042 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1043 i = k;
1044 }
1045 }
1046
1047 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1048 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1049
1050 if (i < len0 + 3
1051 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1052 {
1053 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1054 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1055 digits or lowercase characters. */
1056 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1057
1058 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1059 ptr--;
1060 if (ptr < encoded
1061 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1062 i++;
1063 }
1064
1065 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1066 {
1067 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1068 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1069 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1070 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1071 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1072 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1073 package names. */
1074 do
1075 i += 1;
1076 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1077 if (i < len0)
1078 goto Suppress;
1079 }
1080 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1081 {
1082 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1083 decoded[j] = '.';
1084 at_start_name = 1;
1085 i += 2;
1086 j += 1;
1087 }
1088 else
1089 {
1090 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1091 over. */
1092 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1093 i += 1;
1094 j += 1;
1095 }
1096 }
1097 decoded[j] = '\000';
1098
1099 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1100 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1101
1102 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1103 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1104 goto Suppress;
1105
1106 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1107 return encoded;
1108 else
1109 return decoded;
1110
1111 Suppress:
1112 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1113 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1114 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1115 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1116 else
1117 sprintf (decoded, "<%s>", encoded);
1118 return decoded;
1119
1120 }
1121
1122 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1123 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1124 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1125 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1126 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1127 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1128
1129 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1130 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1131 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1132 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1133 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1134 GSYMBOL).
1135 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1136 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1137 when a decoded name is cached in it.
1138 */
1139
1140 char *
1141 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1142 {
1143 char **resultp =
1144 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.cplus_specific.demangled_name;
1145 if (*resultp == NULL)
1146 {
1147 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1148 if (gsymbol->obj_section != NULL)
1149 {
1150 struct objfile *objf = gsymbol->obj_section->objfile;
1151 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1152 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1153 }
1154 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1155 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1156 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1157 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1158 if (*resultp == NULL)
1159 {
1160 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1161 decoded, INSERT);
1162 if (*slot == NULL)
1163 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1164 *resultp = *slot;
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 return *resultp;
1169 }
1170
1171 static char *
1172 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1173 {
1174 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1175 }
1176
1177 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1178 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1179 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1180 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1181 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1182 either argument is NULL. */
1183
1184 static int
1185 ada_match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1186 {
1187 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1188 return 0;
1189 else if (wild)
1190 return wild_match (name, strlen (name), sym_name);
1191 else
1192 {
1193 int len_name = strlen (name);
1194 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1195 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1196 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1197 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1198 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1199 }
1200 }
1201 \f
1202
1203 /* Arrays */
1204
1205 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1206
1207 static char *bound_name[] = {
1208 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1209 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1210 };
1211
1212 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1213
1214 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1215
1216 /* Like modify_field, but allows bitpos > wordlength. */
1217
1218 static void
1219 modify_general_field (char *addr, LONGEST fieldval, int bitpos, int bitsize)
1220 {
1221 modify_field (addr + bitpos / 8, fieldval, bitpos % 8, bitsize);
1222 }
1223
1224
1225 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1226 (fat pointers). */
1227
1228 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1229 level of indirection, if needed. */
1230
1231 static struct type *
1232 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1233 {
1234 if (type == NULL)
1235 return NULL;
1236 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1237 if (type != NULL
1238 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1239 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1240 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1241 else
1242 return type;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1246
1247 static int
1248 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1249 {
1250 return
1251 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1252 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1253 }
1254
1255 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1256
1257 static struct type *
1258 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1259 {
1260 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1261 if (base_type == NULL)
1262 return NULL;
1263 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1264 return base_type;
1265 else
1266 {
1267 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1268 if (alt_type == NULL)
1269 return base_type;
1270 else
1271 return alt_type;
1272 }
1273 }
1274
1275 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1276
1277 static struct value *
1278 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1279 {
1280 struct type *type = value_type (val);
1281 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1282 return value_cast (desc_data_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)),
1283 value_copy (val));
1284 else
1285 return value_from_longest (desc_data_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)),
1286 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val));
1287 }
1288
1289 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1290
1291 static int
1292 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1293 {
1294 type = desc_base_type (type);
1295 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1296 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1297 }
1298
1299 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1300 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1301
1302 static struct type *
1303 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1304 {
1305 struct type *r;
1306
1307 type = desc_base_type (type);
1308
1309 if (type == NULL)
1310 return NULL;
1311 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1312 {
1313 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1314 if (type == NULL)
1315 return NULL;
1316 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1317 if (r != NULL)
1318 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1319 }
1320 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1321 {
1322 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1323 if (r != NULL)
1324 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1325 }
1326 return NULL;
1327 }
1328
1329 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1330 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1331
1332 static struct value *
1333 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1334 {
1335 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1336 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1337 {
1338 struct type *bounds_type =
1339 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1340 LONGEST addr;
1341
1342 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1343 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1344
1345 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1346 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1347 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1348 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1349 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1350 else
1351 addr = VALUE_ADDRESS (arr) + value_offset (arr);
1352
1353 return
1354 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1355 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1356 }
1357
1358 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1359 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1360 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1361 else
1362 return NULL;
1363 }
1364
1365 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1366 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1367
1368 static int
1369 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1370 {
1371 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1372 }
1373
1374 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1375 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1376
1377 static int
1378 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1379 {
1380 type = desc_base_type (type);
1381
1382 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1383 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1384 else
1385 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1386 }
1387
1388 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1389 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a
1390 pointer-to-array-with-no-bounds type); otherwise, NULL. Use
1391 ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds data. */
1392
1393 static struct type *
1394 desc_data_type (struct type *type)
1395 {
1396 type = desc_base_type (type);
1397
1398 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1399 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1400 return lookup_pointer_type
1401 (desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1)));
1402 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1403 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1404 else
1405 return NULL;
1406 }
1407
1408 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1409 its array data. */
1410
1411 static struct value *
1412 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1413 {
1414 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1415 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1416 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1417 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1418 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1419 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1420 else
1421 return NULL;
1422 }
1423
1424
1425 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1426 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1427
1428 static int
1429 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1430 {
1431 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1432 }
1433
1434 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1435 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1436
1437 static int
1438 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1439 {
1440 type = desc_base_type (type);
1441
1442 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1443 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1444 else
1445 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1446 }
1447
1448 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1449 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1450 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1451
1452 static struct value *
1453 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1454 {
1455 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1456 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1457 }
1458
1459 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1460 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1461 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1462
1463 static int
1464 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1465 {
1466 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1467 }
1468
1469 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1470 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1471 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1472
1473 static int
1474 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1475 {
1476 type = desc_base_type (type);
1477
1478 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1479 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1480 else
1481 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1482 }
1483
1484 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1485 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1486
1487 static struct type *
1488 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1489 {
1490 type = desc_base_type (type);
1491
1492 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1493 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1494 else
1495 return NULL;
1496 }
1497
1498 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1499 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1500
1501 static int
1502 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1503 {
1504 type = desc_base_type (type);
1505
1506 if (type != NULL)
1507 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1508 return 0;
1509 }
1510
1511 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1512 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1513 type). */
1514
1515 static int
1516 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1517 {
1518 if (type == NULL)
1519 return 0;
1520 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1521 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1522 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1523 }
1524
1525 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1526 * to one. */
1527
1528 static int
1529 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1530 {
1531 while (type != NULL
1532 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1533 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1534 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1535 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1536 }
1537
1538 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1539
1540 int
1541 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1542 {
1543 if (type == NULL)
1544 return 0;
1545 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1546 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1547 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1548 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1549 }
1550
1551 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1552
1553 int
1554 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1555 {
1556 struct type *data_type = desc_data_type (type);
1557
1558 if (type == NULL)
1559 return 0;
1560 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1561 return
1562 data_type != NULL
1563 && ((TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1564 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type) != NULL
1565 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1566 || TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1567 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0;
1568 }
1569
1570 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1571 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1572 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1573 is still needed. */
1574
1575 int
1576 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1577 {
1578 return
1579 type != NULL
1580 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1581 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1582 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1583 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1584 }
1585
1586
1587 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1588 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1589 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1590 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1591 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1592 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1593 a descriptor. */
1594 struct type *
1595 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1596 {
1597 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1598 return decode_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1599
1600 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1601 return value_type (arr);
1602
1603 if (!bounds)
1604 return
1605 ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (desc_data_type (value_type (arr))));
1606 else
1607 {
1608 struct type *elt_type;
1609 int arity;
1610 struct value *descriptor;
1611 struct objfile *objf = TYPE_OBJFILE (value_type (arr));
1612
1613 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1614 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1615
1616 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1617 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1618
1619 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1620 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1621 return NULL;
1622 while (arity > 0)
1623 {
1624 struct type *range_type = alloc_type (objf);
1625 struct type *array_type = alloc_type (objf);
1626 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1627 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1628 arity -= 1;
1629
1630 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1631 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1632 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1633 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1634 }
1635
1636 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1637 }
1638 }
1639
1640 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1641 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1642 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1643 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1644
1645 struct value *
1646 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1647 {
1648 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1649 {
1650 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1651 if (arrType == NULL)
1652 return NULL;
1653 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1654 }
1655 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1656 return decode_packed_array (arr);
1657 else
1658 return arr;
1659 }
1660
1661 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1662 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1663 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1664
1665 static struct value *
1666 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1667 {
1668 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1669 {
1670 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1671 if (arrVal == NULL)
1672 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1673 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1674 return value_ind (arrVal);
1675 }
1676 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1677 return decode_packed_array (arr);
1678 else
1679 return arr;
1680 }
1681
1682 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1683 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1684 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1685
1686 struct type *
1687 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1688 {
1689 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
1690 struct value *dummy = value_from_longest (builtin_type_int32, 0);
1691 struct type *result;
1692 deprecated_set_value_type (dummy, type);
1693 result = ada_type_of_array (dummy, 0);
1694 value_free_to_mark (mark);
1695 return result;
1696 }
1697
1698 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1699
1700 int
1701 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1702 {
1703 if (type == NULL)
1704 return 0;
1705 type = desc_base_type (type);
1706 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1707 return
1708 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1709 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1710 }
1711
1712 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
1713 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
1714 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
1715 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
1716 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
1717 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
1718 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
1719 in bits. */
1720
1721 static struct type *
1722 packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
1723 {
1724 struct type *new_elt_type;
1725 struct type *new_type;
1726 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
1727
1728 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1729 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1730 return type;
1731
1732 new_type = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
1733 new_elt_type = packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
1734 elt_bits);
1735 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
1736 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
1737 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
1738
1739 if (get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type),
1740 &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
1741 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
1742 if (high_bound < low_bound)
1743 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
1744 else
1745 {
1746 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
1747 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
1748 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1749 }
1750
1751 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
1752 return new_type;
1753 }
1754
1755 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where ada_is_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
1756
1757 static struct type *
1758 decode_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1759 {
1760 struct symbol *sym;
1761 struct block **blocks;
1762 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1763 char *name;
1764 char *tail;
1765 struct type *shadow_type;
1766 long bits;
1767 int i, n;
1768
1769 if (!raw_name)
1770 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1771
1772 if (!raw_name)
1773 return NULL;
1774
1775 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
1776 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1777 type = desc_base_type (type);
1778
1779 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
1780 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
1781
1782 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN);
1783 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_TYPE (sym) == NULL)
1784 {
1785 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
1786 return NULL;
1787 }
1788 shadow_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
1789 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
1790
1791 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1792 {
1793 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds information on packed array"));
1794 return NULL;
1795 }
1796
1797 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
1798 {
1799 lim_warning
1800 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
1801 return NULL;
1802 }
1803
1804 return packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
1805 }
1806
1807 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT packed array,
1808 returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
1809 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
1810 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
1811 type length is set appropriately. */
1812
1813 static struct value *
1814 decode_packed_array (struct value *arr)
1815 {
1816 struct type *type;
1817
1818 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
1819 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arr)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1820 arr = ada_value_ind (arr);
1821
1822 type = decode_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1823 if (type == NULL)
1824 {
1825 error (_("can't unpack array"));
1826 return NULL;
1827 }
1828
1829 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch)
1830 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
1831 {
1832 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
1833 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
1834 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
1835 first left-justify it. */
1836 int bit_size, bit_pos;
1837 ULONGEST mod;
1838
1839 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
1840 bit_size = 0;
1841 while (mod > 0)
1842 {
1843 bit_size += 1;
1844 mod >>= 1;
1845 }
1846 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
1847 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
1848 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1849 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1850 bit_size,
1851 type);
1852 }
1853
1854 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
1855 }
1856
1857
1858 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
1859 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
1860
1861 static struct value *
1862 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
1863 {
1864 int i;
1865 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
1866 long elt_total_bit_offset;
1867 struct type *elt_type;
1868 struct value *v;
1869
1870 bits = 0;
1871 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
1872 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1873 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
1874 {
1875 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1876 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
1877 error
1878 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of something other than a packed array"));
1879 else
1880 {
1881 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
1882 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
1883 LONGEST idx;
1884
1885 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
1886 {
1887 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
1888 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
1889 }
1890
1891 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
1892 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
1893 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"), (long) idx);
1894 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1895 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
1896 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
1897 }
1898 }
1899 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1900 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1901
1902 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
1903 bits, elt_type);
1904 return v;
1905 }
1906
1907 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
1908
1909 static int
1910 has_negatives (struct type *type)
1911 {
1912 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
1913 {
1914 default:
1915 return 0;
1916 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
1917 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
1918 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
1919 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
1920 }
1921 }
1922
1923
1924 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
1925 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
1926 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
1927 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
1928 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
1929 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
1930 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
1931 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
1932
1933 struct value *
1934 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
1935 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
1936 struct type *type)
1937 {
1938 struct value *v;
1939 int src, /* Index into the source area */
1940 targ, /* Index into the target area */
1941 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
1942 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
1943 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
1944 byte of source that are unused */
1945 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
1946 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
1947 unsigned char *unpacked;
1948 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
1949 unsigned char sign;
1950 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
1951 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
1952 the indices move. */
1953 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch) ? -1 : 1;
1954
1955 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1956
1957 if (obj == NULL)
1958 {
1959 v = allocate_value (type);
1960 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
1961 }
1962 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
1963 {
1964 v = value_at (type,
1965 VALUE_ADDRESS (obj) + value_offset (obj) + offset);
1966 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
1967 read_memory (VALUE_ADDRESS (v), bytes, len);
1968 }
1969 else
1970 {
1971 v = allocate_value (type);
1972 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
1973 }
1974
1975 if (obj != NULL)
1976 {
1977 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
1978 VALUE_ADDRESS (v) += value_offset (obj) + offset;
1979 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
1980 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
1981 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
1982 {
1983 VALUE_ADDRESS (v) += 1;
1984 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
1985 }
1986 }
1987 else
1988 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
1989 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
1990
1991 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
1992 nsrc = len;
1993 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
1994 sign = 0;
1995 if (bit_size == 0)
1996 {
1997 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
1998 return v;
1999 }
2000 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2001 {
2002 src = len - 1;
2003 if (has_negatives (type)
2004 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2005 sign = ~0;
2006
2007 unusedLS =
2008 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2009 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2010
2011 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2012 {
2013 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2014 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2015 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2016 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2017 accumSize =
2018 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2019 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2020 of the target. */
2021 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2022 ntarg = targ + 1;
2023 break;
2024 default:
2025 accumSize = 0;
2026 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2027 break;
2028 }
2029 }
2030 else
2031 {
2032 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2033
2034 src = targ = 0;
2035 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2036 accumSize = 0;
2037
2038 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2039 sign = ~0;
2040 }
2041
2042 accum = 0;
2043 while (nsrc > 0)
2044 {
2045 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2046 part of the value. */
2047 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2048 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2049 1;
2050 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2051 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2052 accum |=
2053 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2054 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2055 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2056 {
2057 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2058 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2059 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2060 ntarg -= 1;
2061 targ += delta;
2062 }
2063 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2064 unusedLS = 0;
2065 nsrc -= 1;
2066 src += delta;
2067 }
2068 while (ntarg > 0)
2069 {
2070 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2071 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2072 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2073 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2074 ntarg -= 1;
2075 targ += delta;
2076 }
2077
2078 return v;
2079 }
2080
2081 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2082 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2083 not overlap. */
2084 static void
2085 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2086 int src_offset, int n)
2087 {
2088 unsigned int accum, mask;
2089 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2090
2091 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2092 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2093 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2094 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2095 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2096 {
2097 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2098 source += 1;
2099 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2100
2101 while (n > 0)
2102 {
2103 int unused_right;
2104 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2105 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2106 source += 1;
2107 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2108 if (chunk_size > n)
2109 chunk_size = n;
2110 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2111 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2112 *target =
2113 (*target & ~mask)
2114 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2115 n -= chunk_size;
2116 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2117 target += 1;
2118 targ_offset = 0;
2119 }
2120 }
2121 else
2122 {
2123 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2124 source += 1;
2125 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2126
2127 while (n > 0)
2128 {
2129 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2130 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2131 source += 1;
2132 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2133 if (chunk_size > n)
2134 chunk_size = n;
2135 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2136 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2137 n -= chunk_size;
2138 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2139 accum >>= chunk_size;
2140 target += 1;
2141 targ_offset = 0;
2142 }
2143 }
2144 }
2145
2146 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2147 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2148 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2149 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2150
2151 static struct value *
2152 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2153 {
2154 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2155 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2156
2157 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2158 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2159
2160 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2161 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2162 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2163 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2164
2165 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2166 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2167
2168 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2169 && bits > 0
2170 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2171 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2172 {
2173 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2174 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2175 int from_size;
2176 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2177 struct value *val;
2178 CORE_ADDR to_addr = VALUE_ADDRESS (toval) + value_offset (toval);
2179
2180 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2181 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2182
2183 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2184 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2185 if (from_size == 0)
2186 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2187 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2188 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2189 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits);
2190 else
2191 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval), value_contents (fromval),
2192 0, bits);
2193 write_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2194 if (deprecated_memory_changed_hook)
2195 deprecated_memory_changed_hook (to_addr, len);
2196
2197 val = value_copy (toval);
2198 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2199 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2200 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2201
2202 return val;
2203 }
2204
2205 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2206 }
2207
2208
2209 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2210 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2211 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2212 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2213 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2214 static void
2215 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2216 struct value *val)
2217 {
2218 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2219 (LONGEST) (VALUE_ADDRESS (component) + value_offset (component)
2220 - VALUE_ADDRESS (container) - value_offset (container));
2221 int bit_offset_in_container =
2222 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2223 int bits;
2224
2225 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2226
2227 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2228 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2229 else
2230 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2231
2232 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2233 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2234 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2235 value_contents (val),
2236 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2237 bits);
2238 else
2239 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2240 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2241 value_contents (val), 0, bits);
2242 }
2243
2244 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2245 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2246 thereto. */
2247
2248 struct value *
2249 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2250 {
2251 int k;
2252 struct value *elt;
2253 struct type *elt_type;
2254
2255 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2256
2257 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2258 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2259 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2260 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2261
2262 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2263 {
2264 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2265 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2266 elt = value_subscript (elt, value_pos_atr (builtin_type_int32, ind[k]));
2267 }
2268 return elt;
2269 }
2270
2271 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2272 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2273 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2274
2275 static struct value *
2276 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2277 struct value **ind)
2278 {
2279 int k;
2280
2281 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2282 {
2283 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2284 struct value *idx;
2285
2286 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2287 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2288 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2289 value_copy (arr));
2290 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2291 idx = value_pos_atr (builtin_type_int32, ind[k]);
2292 if (lwb != 0)
2293 idx = value_binop (idx, value_from_longest (value_type (idx), lwb),
2294 BINOP_SUB);
2295
2296 arr = value_ptradd (arr, idx);
2297 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2298 }
2299
2300 return value_ind (arr);
2301 }
2302
2303 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2304 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2305 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2306 per Ada rules. */
2307 static struct value *
2308 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2309 int low, int high)
2310 {
2311 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2312 + ((low - TYPE_LOW_BOUND (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)))
2313 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
2314 struct type *index_type =
2315 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)),
2316 low, high);
2317 struct type *slice_type =
2318 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2319 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2320 }
2321
2322
2323 static struct value *
2324 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2325 {
2326 struct type *type = value_type (array);
2327 struct type *index_type =
2328 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2329 struct type *slice_type =
2330 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2331 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2332 }
2333
2334 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2335 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2336 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2337 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2338
2339 int
2340 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2341 {
2342 int arity;
2343
2344 if (type == NULL)
2345 return 0;
2346
2347 type = desc_base_type (type);
2348
2349 arity = 0;
2350 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2351 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2352 else
2353 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2354 {
2355 arity += 1;
2356 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2357 }
2358
2359 return arity;
2360 }
2361
2362 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2363 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2364 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2365 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2366
2367 struct type *
2368 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2369 {
2370 type = desc_base_type (type);
2371
2372 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2373 {
2374 int k;
2375 struct type *p_array_type;
2376
2377 p_array_type = desc_data_type (type);
2378
2379 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2380 if (k == 0)
2381 return NULL;
2382
2383 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2384 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2385 k = nindices;
2386 p_array_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type);
2387 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2388 {
2389 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2390 k -= 1;
2391 }
2392 return p_array_type;
2393 }
2394 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2395 {
2396 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2397 {
2398 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2399 nindices -= 1;
2400 }
2401 return type;
2402 }
2403
2404 return NULL;
2405 }
2406
2407 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2408 Does not examine memory. */
2409
2410 struct type *
2411 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n)
2412 {
2413 struct type *result_type;
2414
2415 type = desc_base_type (type);
2416
2417 if (n > ada_array_arity (type))
2418 return NULL;
2419
2420 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2421 {
2422 int i;
2423
2424 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2425 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2426 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2427 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2428 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2429 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2430 if (result_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2431 result_type = builtin_type_int32;
2432
2433 return result_type;
2434 }
2435 else
2436 return desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2437 }
2438
2439 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2440 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2441 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2442 array-descriptor type. If TYPEP is non-null, *TYPEP is set to the
2443 bounds type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied by
2444 run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2445
2446 static LONGEST
2447 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which,
2448 struct type ** typep)
2449 {
2450 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2451 LONGEST retval;
2452
2453 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2454
2455 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2456 arr_type = decode_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2457
2458 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2459 {
2460 if (typep != NULL)
2461 *typep = builtin_type_int32;
2462 return (LONGEST) - which;
2463 }
2464
2465 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2466 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2467 else
2468 type = arr_type;
2469
2470 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2471 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2472 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2473 NULL, TYPE_OBJFILE (arr_type));
2474 else
2475 {
2476 while (n > 1)
2477 {
2478 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2479 n -= 1;
2480 }
2481
2482 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2483 }
2484
2485 switch (TYPE_CODE (index_type))
2486 {
2487 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2488 retval = which == 0 ? TYPE_LOW_BOUND (index_type)
2489 : TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (index_type);
2490 break;
2491 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
2492 retval = which == 0 ? TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type, 0)
2493 : TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type,
2494 TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type) - 1);
2495 break;
2496 default:
2497 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("invalid type code of index type"));
2498 }
2499
2500 if (typep != NULL)
2501 *typep = index_type;
2502
2503 return retval;
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2507 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2508 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2509 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2510
2511 struct value *
2512 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2513 {
2514 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2515
2516 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2517 return ada_array_bound (decode_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2518 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2519 {
2520 struct type *type;
2521 LONGEST v = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which, &type);
2522 return value_from_longest (type, v);
2523 }
2524 else
2525 return desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which);
2526 }
2527
2528 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2529 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2530 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2531 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2532 clauses at the moment. */
2533
2534 static struct value *
2535 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2536 {
2537 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2538
2539 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2540 return ada_array_length (decode_packed_array (arr), n);
2541
2542 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2543 {
2544 struct type *type;
2545 LONGEST v =
2546 ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1, &type) -
2547 ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0, NULL) + 1;
2548 return value_from_longest (type, v);
2549 }
2550 else
2551 return
2552 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int32,
2553 value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr),
2554 n, 1))
2555 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr),
2556 n, 0)) + 1);
2557 }
2558
2559 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2560 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2561
2562 static struct value *
2563 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2564 {
2565 struct type *index_type =
2566 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type)),
2567 low, low - 1);
2568 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type, 1);
2569 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2570 }
2571 \f
2572
2573 /* Name resolution */
2574
2575 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2576 to OP. */
2577
2578 static const char *
2579 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2580 {
2581 int i;
2582
2583 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2584 {
2585 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2586 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2587 }
2588 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2589 }
2590
2591
2592 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2593 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2594 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2595 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2596 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2597 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2598 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2599 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2600
2601 static void
2602 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2603 {
2604 int pc;
2605 pc = 0;
2606 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, void_context_p ? builtin_type_void : NULL);
2607 }
2608
2609 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2610 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2611 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2612 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2613 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2614 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2615 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2616 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2617
2618 static struct value *
2619 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2620 struct type *context_type)
2621 {
2622 int pc = *pos;
2623 int i;
2624 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2625 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2626 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2627 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2628 int oplen;
2629
2630 argvec = NULL;
2631 nargs = 0;
2632 exp = *expp;
2633
2634 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2635 if needed. */
2636 switch (op)
2637 {
2638 case OP_FUNCALL:
2639 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2640 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2641 *pos += 7;
2642 else
2643 {
2644 *pos += 3;
2645 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2646 }
2647 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2648 break;
2649
2650 case UNOP_ADDR:
2651 *pos += 1;
2652 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2653 break;
2654
2655 case UNOP_QUAL:
2656 *pos += 3;
2657 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2658 break;
2659
2660 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2661 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
2662 case OP_ATR_TAG:
2663 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
2664 case OP_ATR_LAST:
2665 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
2666 case OP_ATR_POS:
2667 case OP_ATR_VAL:
2668 case OP_ATR_MIN:
2669 case OP_ATR_MAX:
2670 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2671 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2672 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
2673 case OP_AGGREGATE:
2674 case OP_OTHERS:
2675 case OP_CHOICES:
2676 case OP_POSITIONAL:
2677 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2678 case OP_NAME:
2679 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
2680 *pos += oplen;
2681 break;
2682
2683 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
2684 {
2685 struct value *arg1;
2686
2687 *pos += 1;
2688 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2689 if (arg1 == NULL)
2690 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2691 else
2692 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
2693 break;
2694 }
2695
2696 case UNOP_CAST:
2697 *pos += 3;
2698 nargs = 1;
2699 break;
2700
2701 case BINOP_ADD:
2702 case BINOP_SUB:
2703 case BINOP_MUL:
2704 case BINOP_DIV:
2705 case BINOP_REM:
2706 case BINOP_MOD:
2707 case BINOP_EXP:
2708 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2709 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
2710 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
2711 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2712 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2713 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2714
2715 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2716 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2717 case BINOP_LESS:
2718 case BINOP_GTR:
2719 case BINOP_LEQ:
2720 case BINOP_GEQ:
2721
2722 case BINOP_REPEAT:
2723 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
2724 case BINOP_COMMA:
2725 *pos += 1;
2726 nargs = 2;
2727 break;
2728
2729 case UNOP_NEG:
2730 case UNOP_PLUS:
2731 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2732 case UNOP_ABS:
2733 case UNOP_IND:
2734 *pos += 1;
2735 nargs = 1;
2736 break;
2737
2738 case OP_LONG:
2739 case OP_DOUBLE:
2740 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2741 *pos += 4;
2742 break;
2743
2744 case OP_TYPE:
2745 case OP_BOOL:
2746 case OP_LAST:
2747 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
2748 *pos += 3;
2749 break;
2750
2751 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
2752 *pos += 3;
2753 nargs = 1;
2754 break;
2755
2756 case OP_REGISTER:
2757 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2758 break;
2759
2760 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
2761 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2762 nargs = 1;
2763 break;
2764
2765 case TERNOP_SLICE:
2766 *pos += 1;
2767 nargs = 3;
2768 break;
2769
2770 case OP_STRING:
2771 break;
2772
2773 default:
2774 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
2775 }
2776
2777 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
2778 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
2779 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2780 argvec[i] = NULL;
2781 exp = *expp;
2782
2783 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
2784 switch (op)
2785 {
2786 default:
2787 break;
2788
2789 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2790 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2791 {
2792 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2793 int n_candidates;
2794
2795 n_candidates =
2796 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2797 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2798 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2799 &candidates);
2800
2801 if (n_candidates > 1)
2802 {
2803 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
2804 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
2805 out all types. */
2806 int j;
2807 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
2808 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
2809 {
2810 case LOC_REGISTER:
2811 case LOC_ARG:
2812 case LOC_REF_ARG:
2813 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
2814 case LOC_LOCAL:
2815 case LOC_COMPUTED:
2816 goto FoundNonType;
2817 default:
2818 break;
2819 }
2820 FoundNonType:
2821 if (j < n_candidates)
2822 {
2823 j = 0;
2824 while (j < n_candidates)
2825 {
2826 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
2827 {
2828 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
2829 n_candidates -= 1;
2830 }
2831 else
2832 j += 1;
2833 }
2834 }
2835 }
2836
2837 if (n_candidates == 0)
2838 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
2839 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2840 else if (n_candidates == 1)
2841 i = 0;
2842 else if (deprocedure_p
2843 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
2844 {
2845 i = ada_resolve_function
2846 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
2847 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2848 context_type);
2849 if (i < 0)
2850 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2851 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2852 }
2853 else
2854 {
2855 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
2856 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2857 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
2858 i = 0;
2859 }
2860
2861 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
2862 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2863 if (innermost_block == NULL
2864 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2865 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2866 }
2867
2868 if (deprocedure_p
2869 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
2870 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
2871 {
2872 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
2873 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
2874 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
2875 exp = *expp;
2876 }
2877 break;
2878
2879 case OP_FUNCALL:
2880 {
2881 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2882 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2883 {
2884 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2885 int n_candidates;
2886
2887 n_candidates =
2888 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2889 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2890 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2891 &candidates);
2892 if (n_candidates == 1)
2893 i = 0;
2894 else
2895 {
2896 i = ada_resolve_function
2897 (candidates, n_candidates,
2898 argvec, nargs,
2899 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2900 context_type);
2901 if (i < 0)
2902 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2903 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
2904 }
2905
2906 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
2907 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2908 if (innermost_block == NULL
2909 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2910 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2911 }
2912 }
2913 break;
2914 case BINOP_ADD:
2915 case BINOP_SUB:
2916 case BINOP_MUL:
2917 case BINOP_DIV:
2918 case BINOP_REM:
2919 case BINOP_MOD:
2920 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2921 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2922 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2923 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2924 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2925 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2926 case BINOP_LESS:
2927 case BINOP_GTR:
2928 case BINOP_LEQ:
2929 case BINOP_GEQ:
2930 case BINOP_EXP:
2931 case UNOP_NEG:
2932 case UNOP_PLUS:
2933 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2934 case UNOP_ABS:
2935 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
2936 {
2937 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2938 int n_candidates;
2939
2940 n_candidates =
2941 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
2942 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
2943 &candidates);
2944 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
2945 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
2946 if (i < 0)
2947 break;
2948
2949 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
2950 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
2951 exp = *expp;
2952 }
2953 break;
2954
2955 case OP_TYPE:
2956 case OP_REGISTER:
2957 return NULL;
2958 }
2959
2960 *pos = pc;
2961 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
2962 }
2963
2964 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
2965 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
2966 a non-pointer. A type of 'void' (which is never a valid expression type)
2967 by convention matches anything. */
2968 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
2969 liberal. FIXME: TOO liberal, in fact. */
2970
2971 static int
2972 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
2973 {
2974 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
2975 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
2976
2977 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
2978 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
2979 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
2980 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
2981
2982 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_VOID
2983 || TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
2984 return 1;
2985
2986 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
2987 {
2988 default:
2989 return 1;
2990 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
2991 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2992 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
2993 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
2994 else
2995 return (may_deref
2996 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
2997 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2998 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
2999 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3000 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3001 {
3002 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3003 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3004 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3005 return 1;
3006 default:
3007 return 0;
3008 }
3009
3010 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3011 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3012 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3013
3014 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3015 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3016 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3017 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3018 else
3019 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3020 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3021
3022 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3023 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3024 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3025 }
3026 }
3027
3028 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3029 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3030 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3031 argument function. */
3032
3033 static int
3034 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3035 {
3036 int i;
3037 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3038
3039 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3040 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3041 return (n_actuals == 0);
3042 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3043 return 0;
3044
3045 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3046 return 0;
3047
3048 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3049 {
3050 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3051 return 0;
3052 else
3053 {
3054 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type, i));
3055 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3056
3057 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3058 return 0;
3059 }
3060 }
3061 return 1;
3062 }
3063
3064 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3065 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3066 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3067 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3068
3069 static int
3070 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3071 {
3072 struct type *return_type;
3073
3074 if (func_type == NULL)
3075 return 1;
3076
3077 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3078 return_type = base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3079 else
3080 return_type = base_type (func_type);
3081 if (return_type == NULL)
3082 return 1;
3083
3084 context_type = base_type (context_type);
3085
3086 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3087 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3088 else if (context_type == NULL)
3089 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3090 else
3091 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3092 }
3093
3094
3095 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3096 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3097 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3098 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3099 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3100 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3101
3102 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3103 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3104 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3105 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3106
3107 static int
3108 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3109 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3110 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3111 {
3112 int k;
3113 int m; /* Number of hits */
3114 struct type *fallback;
3115 struct type *return_type;
3116
3117 return_type = context_type;
3118 if (context_type == NULL)
3119 fallback = builtin_type_void;
3120 else
3121 fallback = NULL;
3122
3123 m = 0;
3124 while (1)
3125 {
3126 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3127 {
3128 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3129
3130 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3131 && return_match (type, return_type))
3132 {
3133 syms[m] = syms[k];
3134 m += 1;
3135 }
3136 }
3137 if (m > 0 || return_type == fallback)
3138 break;
3139 else
3140 return_type = fallback;
3141 }
3142
3143 if (m == 0)
3144 return -1;
3145 else if (m > 1)
3146 {
3147 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3148 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3149 return 0;
3150 }
3151 return 0;
3152 }
3153
3154 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3155 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3156 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3157 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3158 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3159
3160 static int
3161 encoded_ordered_before (char *N0, char *N1)
3162 {
3163 if (N1 == NULL)
3164 return 0;
3165 else if (N0 == NULL)
3166 return 1;
3167 else
3168 {
3169 int k0, k1;
3170 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3171 ;
3172 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3173 ;
3174 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3175 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3176 {
3177 int n0, n1;
3178 n0 = k0;
3179 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3180 n0 -= 1;
3181 n1 = k1;
3182 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3183 n1 -= 1;
3184 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3185 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3186 }
3187 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3188 }
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3192 encoded names. */
3193
3194 static void
3195 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3196 {
3197 int i;
3198 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3199 {
3200 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3201 int j;
3202
3203 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3204 {
3205 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3206 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3207 break;
3208 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3209 }
3210 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3211 }
3212 }
3213
3214 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3215 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3216 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3217 selected. */
3218
3219 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3220 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3221
3222 int
3223 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3224 {
3225 int i;
3226 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3227 int n_chosen;
3228 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3229 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3230
3231 if (max_results < 1)
3232 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3233 if (nsyms <= 1)
3234 return nsyms;
3235
3236 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3237 error (_("\
3238 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3239 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3240
3241 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3242 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3243 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3244 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3245 return nsyms;
3246
3247 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3248 if (max_results > 1)
3249 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3250
3251 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3252
3253 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3254 {
3255 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3256 continue;
3257
3258 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3259 {
3260 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3261 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3262 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3263 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3264 i + first_choice,
3265 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3266 sal.line);
3267 else
3268 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3269 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3270 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3271 continue;
3272 }
3273 else
3274 {
3275 int is_enumeral =
3276 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3277 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3278 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3279 struct symtab *symtab = symtab_for_sym (syms[i].sym);
3280
3281 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3282 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3283 i + first_choice,
3284 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3285 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3286 else if (is_enumeral
3287 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3288 {
3289 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3290 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3291 gdb_stdout, -1, 0);
3292 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3293 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3294 }
3295 else if (symtab != NULL)
3296 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3297 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3298 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3299 i + first_choice,
3300 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3301 symtab->filename);
3302 else
3303 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3304 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3305 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3306 i + first_choice,
3307 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3308 }
3309 }
3310
3311 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3312 "overload-choice");
3313
3314 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3315 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3316
3317 return n_chosen;
3318 }
3319
3320 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3321 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3322 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3323
3324 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3325 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3326
3327 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3328 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3329 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3330
3331 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3332
3333 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3334 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3335
3336 int
3337 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3338 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3339 {
3340 char *args;
3341 char *prompt;
3342 int n_chosen;
3343 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3344
3345 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3346 if (prompt == NULL)
3347 prompt = "> ";
3348
3349 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3350
3351 if (args == NULL)
3352 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3353
3354 n_chosen = 0;
3355
3356 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3357 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3358 while (1)
3359 {
3360 char *args2;
3361 int choice, j;
3362
3363 while (isspace (*args))
3364 args += 1;
3365 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3366 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3367 else if (*args == '\0')
3368 break;
3369
3370 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3371 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3372 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3373 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3374 args = args2;
3375
3376 if (choice == 0)
3377 error (_("cancelled"));
3378
3379 if (choice < first_choice)
3380 {
3381 n_chosen = n_choices;
3382 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3383 choices[j] = j;
3384 break;
3385 }
3386 choice -= first_choice;
3387
3388 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3389 {
3390 }
3391
3392 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3393 {
3394 int k;
3395 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3396 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3397 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3398 n_chosen += 1;
3399 }
3400 }
3401
3402 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3403 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3404
3405 return n_chosen;
3406 }
3407
3408 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3409 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3410 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3411
3412 static void
3413 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3414 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3415 struct block *block)
3416 {
3417 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3418 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3419 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3420 xmalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3421 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3422 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3423
3424 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3425 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3426 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3427 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3428 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3429
3430 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3431 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3432
3433 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3434 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3435 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3436
3437 *expp = newexp;
3438 xfree (exp);
3439 }
3440
3441 /* Type-class predicates */
3442
3443 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3444 or FLOAT). */
3445
3446 static int
3447 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3448 {
3449 if (type == NULL)
3450 return 0;
3451 else
3452 {
3453 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3454 {
3455 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3456 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3457 return 1;
3458 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3459 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3460 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3461 default:
3462 return 0;
3463 }
3464 }
3465 }
3466
3467 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3468
3469 static int
3470 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3471 {
3472 if (type == NULL)
3473 return 0;
3474 else
3475 {
3476 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3477 {
3478 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3479 return 1;
3480 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3481 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3482 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3483 default:
3484 return 0;
3485 }
3486 }
3487 }
3488
3489 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3490
3491 static int
3492 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3493 {
3494 if (type == NULL)
3495 return 0;
3496 else
3497 {
3498 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3499 {
3500 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3501 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3502 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3503 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3504 return 1;
3505 default:
3506 return 0;
3507 }
3508 }
3509 }
3510
3511 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3512
3513 static int
3514 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3515 {
3516 if (type == NULL)
3517 return 0;
3518 else
3519 {
3520 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3521 {
3522 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3523 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3524 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3525 return 1;
3526 default:
3527 return 0;
3528 }
3529 }
3530 }
3531
3532 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3533 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3534 (i.e., result 0). */
3535
3536 static int
3537 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3538 {
3539 struct type *type0 =
3540 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3541 struct type *type1 =
3542 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3543
3544 if (type0 == NULL)
3545 return 0;
3546
3547 switch (op)
3548 {
3549 default:
3550 return 0;
3551
3552 case BINOP_ADD:
3553 case BINOP_SUB:
3554 case BINOP_MUL:
3555 case BINOP_DIV:
3556 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3557
3558 case BINOP_REM:
3559 case BINOP_MOD:
3560 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3561 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3562 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3563 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3564
3565 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3566 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3567 case BINOP_LESS:
3568 case BINOP_GTR:
3569 case BINOP_LEQ:
3570 case BINOP_GEQ:
3571 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3572
3573 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3574 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3575
3576 case BINOP_EXP:
3577 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3578
3579 case UNOP_NEG:
3580 case UNOP_PLUS:
3581 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3582 case UNOP_ABS:
3583 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3584
3585 }
3586 }
3587 \f
3588 /* Renaming */
3589
3590 /* NOTES:
3591
3592 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3593 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3594 point.
3595 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3596 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3597 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3598 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3599 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3600 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3601
3602 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3603
3604 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3605
3606 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3607 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3608 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3609 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3610 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3611 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3612 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3613 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3614 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3615 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3616 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3617 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3618
3619 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3620
3621 enum ada_renaming_category
3622 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3623 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3624 const char **renaming_expr)
3625 {
3626 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3627 const char *info;
3628 const char *suffix;
3629
3630 if (sym == NULL)
3631 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3632 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3633 {
3634 default:
3635 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3636 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3637 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3638 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3639 case LOC_LOCAL:
3640 case LOC_STATIC:
3641 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3642 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3643 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3644 if (info == NULL)
3645 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3646 switch (info[5])
3647 {
3648 case '_':
3649 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3650 info += 6;
3651 break;
3652 case 'E':
3653 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3654 info += 7;
3655 break;
3656 case 'P':
3657 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3658 info += 7;
3659 break;
3660 case 'S':
3661 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3662 info += 7;
3663 break;
3664 default:
3665 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3666 }
3667 }
3668
3669 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3670 *renamed_entity = info;
3671 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3672 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3673 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3674 if (len != NULL)
3675 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3676 suffix += 5;
3677 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3678 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3679 return kind;
3680 }
3681
3682 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3683 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3684 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3685 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3686 static enum ada_renaming_category
3687 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3688 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3689 const char **renaming_expr)
3690 {
3691 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3692 const char *name;
3693 const char *info;
3694 const char *suffix;
3695
3696 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3697 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
3698 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3699
3700 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
3701 if (name == NULL)
3702 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3703
3704 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
3705 if (name == NULL)
3706 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3707 switch (name[5])
3708 {
3709 case '\0':
3710 case '_':
3711 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3712 break;
3713 case 'E':
3714 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3715 break;
3716 case 'P':
3717 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3718 break;
3719 case 'S':
3720 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3721 break;
3722 default:
3723 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3724 }
3725
3726 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
3727 if (info == NULL)
3728 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3729 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3730 *renamed_entity = info;
3731 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3732 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3733 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
3734 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3735 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3736 if (len != NULL)
3737 *len = suffix - info;
3738 return kind;
3739 }
3740
3741 \f
3742
3743 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
3744
3745 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
3746 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of pushing a copy of VAL
3747 on the stack, using and updating *SP as the stack pointer, and
3748 returning an lvalue whose VALUE_ADDRESS points to the copy. */
3749
3750 static struct value *
3751 ensure_lval (struct value *val, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3752 {
3753 if (! VALUE_LVAL (val))
3754 {
3755 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
3756
3757 /* The following is taken from the structure-return code in
3758 call_function_by_hand. FIXME: Therefore, some refactoring seems
3759 indicated. */
3760 if (gdbarch_inner_than (current_gdbarch, 1, 2))
3761 {
3762 /* Stack grows downward. Align SP and VALUE_ADDRESS (val) after
3763 reserving sufficient space. */
3764 *sp -= len;
3765 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3766 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3767 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) = *sp;
3768 }
3769 else
3770 {
3771 /* Stack grows upward. Align the frame, allocate space, and
3772 then again, re-align the frame. */
3773 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3774 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3775 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) = *sp;
3776 *sp += len;
3777 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3778 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3779 }
3780 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
3781
3782 write_memory (VALUE_ADDRESS (val), value_contents_raw (val), len);
3783 }
3784
3785 return val;
3786 }
3787
3788 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
3789 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
3790 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
3791 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
3792
3793 struct value *
3794 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0,
3795 CORE_ADDR *sp)
3796 {
3797 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3798 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
3799 struct type *formal_target =
3800 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3801 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
3802 struct type *actual_target =
3803 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3804 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
3805
3806 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
3807 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
3808 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual, sp);
3809 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3810 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3811 {
3812 struct value *result;
3813 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3814 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
3815 result = desc_data (actual);
3816 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3817 {
3818 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
3819 {
3820 struct value *val;
3821 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3822 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
3823 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
3824 (char *) value_contents (actual),
3825 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
3826 actual = ensure_lval (val, sp);
3827 }
3828 result = value_addr (actual);
3829 }
3830 else
3831 return actual;
3832 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result);
3833 }
3834 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3835 return ada_value_ind (actual);
3836
3837 return actual;
3838 }
3839
3840
3841 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
3842 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
3843 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
3844 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
3845 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
3846
3847 static struct value *
3848 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3849 {
3850 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
3851 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
3852 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
3853 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
3854 int i;
3855
3856 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))); i > 0; i -= 1)
3857 {
3858 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3859 value_as_long (ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0)),
3860 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
3861 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
3862 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3863 value_as_long (ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1)),
3864 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
3865 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
3866 }
3867
3868 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds, sp);
3869
3870 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3871 VALUE_ADDRESS (ensure_lval (arr, sp)),
3872 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
3873 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
3874
3875 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3876 VALUE_ADDRESS (bounds),
3877 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
3878 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
3879
3880 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor, sp);
3881
3882 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3883 return value_addr (descriptor);
3884 else
3885 return descriptor;
3886 }
3887 \f
3888 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
3889 * used in the public sources. */
3890
3891 static int
3892 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
3893 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
3894 {
3895 return 0;
3896 }
3897
3898 static void
3899 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
3900 struct block *block)
3901 {
3902 }
3903 \f
3904 /* Symbol Lookup */
3905
3906 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
3907 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
3908
3909 static struct symbol *
3910 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
3911 domain_enum domain)
3912 {
3913 struct symbol *sym;
3914
3915 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
3916 return sym;
3917 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
3918 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
3919 return sym;
3920 }
3921
3922
3923 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
3924 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
3925 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
3926 static int
3927 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
3928 {
3929 int i;
3930
3931 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
3932 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
3933 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3934 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
3935 return 1;
3936
3937 return 0;
3938 }
3939
3940 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
3941 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
3942
3943 static int
3944 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
3945 {
3946 if (type0 == type1)
3947 return 1;
3948 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
3949 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
3950 return 0;
3951 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3952 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3953 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
3954 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
3955 return 1;
3956
3957 return 0;
3958 }
3959
3960 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
3961 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
3962
3963 static int
3964 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
3965 {
3966 if (sym0 == sym1)
3967 return 1;
3968 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
3969 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
3970 return 0;
3971
3972 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
3973 {
3974 case LOC_UNDEF:
3975 return 1;
3976 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3977 {
3978 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
3979 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
3980 char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
3981 char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
3982 int len0 = strlen (name0);
3983 return
3984 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
3985 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
3986 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
3987 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
3988 }
3989 case LOC_CONST:
3990 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
3991 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
3992 default:
3993 return 0;
3994 }
3995 }
3996
3997 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
3998 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
3999
4000 static void
4001 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4002 struct symbol *sym,
4003 struct block *block)
4004 {
4005 int i;
4006 size_t tmp;
4007 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4008
4009 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4010 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4011 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4012 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4013 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4014 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4015 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4016 out the stub ones if needed. */
4017
4018 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4019 {
4020 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4021 return;
4022 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4023 {
4024 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4025 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4026 return;
4027 }
4028 }
4029
4030 {
4031 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4032
4033 info.sym = sym;
4034 info.block = block;
4035 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4036 }
4037 }
4038
4039 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4040 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4041
4042 static int
4043 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4044 {
4045 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4046 }
4047
4048 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4049 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4050 its final address. */
4051
4052 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4053 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4054 {
4055 if (finish)
4056 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4057 else
4058 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4059 }
4060
4061 /* Look, in partial_symtab PST, for symbol NAME in given namespace.
4062 Check the global symbols if GLOBAL, the static symbols if not.
4063 Do wild-card match if WILD. */
4064
4065 static struct partial_symbol *
4066 ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab *pst, const char *name,
4067 int global, domain_enum namespace, int wild)
4068 {
4069 struct partial_symbol **start;
4070 int name_len = strlen (name);
4071 int length = (global ? pst->n_global_syms : pst->n_static_syms);
4072 int i;
4073
4074 if (length == 0)
4075 {
4076 return (NULL);
4077 }
4078
4079 start = (global ?
4080 pst->objfile->global_psymbols.list + pst->globals_offset :
4081 pst->objfile->static_psymbols.list + pst->statics_offset);
4082
4083 if (wild)
4084 {
4085 for (i = 0; i < length; i += 1)
4086 {
4087 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4088
4089 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4090 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace)
4091 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)))
4092 return psym;
4093 }
4094 return NULL;
4095 }
4096 else
4097 {
4098 if (global)
4099 {
4100 int U;
4101 i = 0;
4102 U = length - 1;
4103 while (U - i > 4)
4104 {
4105 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4106 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4107 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < name[0])
4108 i = M + 1;
4109 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > name[0])
4110 U = M - 1;
4111 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name) < 0)
4112 i = M + 1;
4113 else
4114 U = M;
4115 }
4116 }
4117 else
4118 i = 0;
4119
4120 while (i < length)
4121 {
4122 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4123
4124 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4125 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4126 {
4127 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name_len);
4128
4129 if (cmp < 0)
4130 {
4131 if (global)
4132 break;
4133 }
4134 else if (cmp == 0
4135 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4136 + name_len))
4137 return psym;
4138 }
4139 i += 1;
4140 }
4141
4142 if (global)
4143 {
4144 int U;
4145 i = 0;
4146 U = length - 1;
4147 while (U - i > 4)
4148 {
4149 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4150 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4151 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < '_')
4152 i = M + 1;
4153 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > '_')
4154 U = M - 1;
4155 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), "_ada_") < 0)
4156 i = M + 1;
4157 else
4158 U = M;
4159 }
4160 }
4161 else
4162 i = 0;
4163
4164 while (i < length)
4165 {
4166 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4167
4168 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4169 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4170 {
4171 int cmp;
4172
4173 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0];
4174 if (cmp == 0)
4175 {
4176 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), 5);
4177 if (cmp == 0)
4178 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym) + 5,
4179 name_len);
4180 }
4181
4182 if (cmp < 0)
4183 {
4184 if (global)
4185 break;
4186 }
4187 else if (cmp == 0
4188 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4189 + name_len + 5))
4190 return psym;
4191 }
4192 i += 1;
4193 }
4194 }
4195 return NULL;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* Find a symbol table containing symbol SYM or NULL if none. */
4199
4200 static struct symtab *
4201 symtab_for_sym (struct symbol *sym)
4202 {
4203 struct symtab *s;
4204 struct objfile *objfile;
4205 struct block *b;
4206 struct symbol *tmp_sym;
4207 struct dict_iterator iter;
4208 int j;
4209
4210 ALL_PRIMARY_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
4211 {
4212 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4213 {
4214 case LOC_CONST:
4215 case LOC_STATIC:
4216 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4217 case LOC_REGISTER:
4218 case LOC_LABEL:
4219 case LOC_BLOCK:
4220 case LOC_CONST_BYTES:
4221 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
4222 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4223 return s;
4224 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
4225 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4226 return s;
4227 break;
4228 default:
4229 break;
4230 }
4231 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4232 {
4233 case LOC_REGISTER:
4234 case LOC_ARG:
4235 case LOC_REF_ARG:
4236 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
4237 case LOC_LOCAL:
4238 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4239 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4240 for (j = FIRST_LOCAL_BLOCK;
4241 j < BLOCKVECTOR_NBLOCKS (BLOCKVECTOR (s)); j += 1)
4242 {
4243 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), j);
4244 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4245 return s;
4246 }
4247 break;
4248 default:
4249 break;
4250 }
4251 }
4252 return NULL;
4253 }
4254
4255 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4256 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4257 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4258 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4259
4260 struct minimal_symbol *
4261 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4262 {
4263 struct objfile *objfile;
4264 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4265 int wild_match;
4266
4267 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4268 {
4269 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4270 wild_match = 0;
4271 }
4272 else
4273 wild_match = (strstr (name, "__") == NULL);
4274
4275 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4276 {
4277 if (ada_match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match)
4278 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4279 return msymbol;
4280 }
4281
4282 return NULL;
4283 }
4284
4285 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4286 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4287 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4288 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD, treat as NAME with a
4289 wildcard prefix. */
4290
4291 static void
4292 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4293 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4294 int wild_match)
4295 {
4296 }
4297
4298 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4299 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4300
4301 static int
4302 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4303 {
4304 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4305 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4306 }
4307
4308 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4309 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4310 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4311 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4312 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4313 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4314
4315 static int
4316 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4317 {
4318 int i, j;
4319
4320 i = 0;
4321 while (i < nsyms)
4322 {
4323 int remove = 0;
4324
4325 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4326 the get rid of the stub. */
4327
4328 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4329 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4330 {
4331 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4332 {
4333 if (j != i
4334 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4335 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4336 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4337 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4338 remove = 1;
4339 }
4340 }
4341
4342 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4343 should be identical. */
4344
4345 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4346 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4347 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4348 {
4349 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4350 {
4351 if (i != j
4352 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4353 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4354 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4355 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4356 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4357 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4358 remove = 1;
4359 }
4360 }
4361
4362 if (remove)
4363 {
4364 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4365 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4366 nsyms -= 1;
4367 }
4368
4369 i += 1;
4370 }
4371 return nsyms;
4372 }
4373
4374 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4375 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4376 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4377 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4378
4379 static char *
4380 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4381 {
4382 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4383 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4384 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4385 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4386
4387 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4388 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4389 char *last;
4390 int scope_len;
4391 char *scope;
4392
4393 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4394 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4395
4396 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4397 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4398 break;
4399
4400 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4401
4402 scope_len = last - name;
4403 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4404
4405 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4406 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4407
4408 return scope;
4409 }
4410
4411 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4412
4413 static int
4414 is_package_name (const char *name)
4415 {
4416 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4417 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4418 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4419 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4420 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4421
4422 char *fun_name;
4423
4424 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4425 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4426 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4427 return 0;
4428
4429 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4430 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4431
4432 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4433 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4434 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4435 return 0;
4436
4437 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4438
4439 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4440 }
4441
4442 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4443 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4444
4445 static int
4446 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, char *function_name)
4447 {
4448 char *scope;
4449
4450 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4451 return 0;
4452
4453 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4454
4455 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4456
4457 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4458 if (is_package_name (scope))
4459 return 0;
4460
4461 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4462 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4463
4464 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4465 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4466 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4467 this prefix. */
4468 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4469 function_name += 5;
4470
4471 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4472 }
4473
4474 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4475 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4476 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4477 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4478 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4479
4480 Rationale:
4481 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4482 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4483 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4484 latter.
4485
4486 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4487 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4488 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4489 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4490 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4491 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4492 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4493
4494 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4495 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4496 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4497 method with the current information available. The implementation
4498 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4499
4500 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4501 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4502 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4503 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4504 currently not the case.
4505
4506 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4507 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4508 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4509 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4510
4511 static int
4512 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4513 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4514 {
4515 struct symbol *current_function;
4516 char *current_function_name;
4517 int i;
4518 int is_new_style_renaming;
4519
4520 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4521 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4522 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4523 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4524 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4525 {
4526 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4527 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4528 const char *name;
4529 const char *suffix;
4530
4531 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4532 continue;
4533 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4534 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4535
4536 if (suffix != NULL)
4537 {
4538 int name_len = suffix - name;
4539 int j;
4540 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4541 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4542 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4543 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4544 name_len) == 0
4545 && block == syms[j].block)
4546 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4547 }
4548 }
4549 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4550 {
4551 int j, k;
4552
4553 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4554 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4555 {
4556 syms[k] = syms[j];
4557 k += 1;
4558 }
4559 return k;
4560 }
4561
4562 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4563 Abort if unable to do so. */
4564
4565 if (current_block == NULL)
4566 return nsyms;
4567
4568 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4569 if (current_function == NULL)
4570 return nsyms;
4571
4572 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4573 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4574 return nsyms;
4575
4576 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4577 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4578 the current block. */
4579
4580 i = 0;
4581 while (i < nsyms)
4582 {
4583 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4584 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4585 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4586 {
4587 int j;
4588 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4589 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4590 nsyms -= 1;
4591 }
4592 else
4593 i += 1;
4594 }
4595
4596 return nsyms;
4597 }
4598
4599 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4600 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4601 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4602 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4603 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4604
4605 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4606
4607 static void
4608 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4609 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4610 int wild_match)
4611 {
4612 int block_depth = 0;
4613
4614 while (block != NULL)
4615 {
4616 block_depth += 1;
4617 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, wild_match);
4618
4619 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4620 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4621 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4622 return;
4623
4624 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4625 }
4626
4627 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4628 enclosing subprogram. */
4629 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4630 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match);
4631 }
4632
4633 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
4634 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
4635 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
4636
4637 static void
4638 ada_add_non_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4639 domain_enum domain, int global,
4640 int wild_match)
4641 {
4642 struct objfile *objfile;
4643 struct partial_symtab *ps;
4644
4645 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
4646 {
4647 QUIT;
4648 if (ps->readin
4649 || ada_lookup_partial_symbol (ps, name, global, domain, wild_match))
4650 {
4651 struct symtab *s = PSYMTAB_TO_SYMTAB (ps);
4652 const int block_kind = global ? GLOBAL_BLOCK : STATIC_BLOCK;
4653
4654 if (s == NULL || !s->primary)
4655 continue;
4656 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp,
4657 BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), block_kind),
4658 name, domain, objfile, wild_match);
4659 }
4660 }
4661 }
4662
4663 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4664 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches. Sets
4665 *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
4666 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
4667 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
4668 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
4669 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
4670 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
4671 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
4672 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, the
4673 search extends to global and file-scope (static) symbol tables.
4674 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
4675 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4676
4677 int
4678 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
4679 domain_enum namespace,
4680 struct ada_symbol_info **results)
4681 {
4682 struct symbol *sym;
4683 struct block *block;
4684 const char *name;
4685 int wild_match;
4686 int cacheIfUnique;
4687 int ndefns;
4688
4689 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
4690 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
4691
4692 cacheIfUnique = 0;
4693
4694 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
4695
4696 wild_match = (strstr (name0, "__") == NULL);
4697 name = name0;
4698 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
4699 needed, but adding const will
4700 have a cascade effect. */
4701
4702 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4703 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4704 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4705 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4706 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4707 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4708 entity inside its program). */
4709 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4710 {
4711 wild_match = 0;
4712 block = NULL;
4713 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4714 }
4715
4716 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
4717
4718 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block, namespace,
4719 wild_match);
4720 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0)
4721 goto done;
4722
4723 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
4724 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
4725 the same result. */
4726
4727 cacheIfUnique = 1;
4728 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
4729 {
4730 if (sym != NULL)
4731 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
4732 goto done;
4733 }
4734
4735 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
4736
4737 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
4738 wild_match);
4739
4740 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
4741 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
4742
4743 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
4744 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
4745 wild_match);
4746
4747 done:
4748 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
4749 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
4750
4751 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
4752
4753 if (ndefns == 0)
4754 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
4755
4756 if (ndefns == 1 && cacheIfUnique)
4757 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
4758
4759 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
4760
4761 return ndefns;
4762 }
4763
4764 struct symbol *
4765 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4766 domain_enum namespace, struct block **block_found)
4767 {
4768 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
4769 int n_candidates;
4770
4771 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, namespace, &candidates);
4772
4773 if (n_candidates == 0)
4774 return NULL;
4775
4776 if (block_found != NULL)
4777 *block_found = candidates[0].block;
4778
4779 return fixup_symbol_section (candidates[0].sym, NULL);
4780 }
4781
4782 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4783 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
4784 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
4785 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
4786 *IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is set to 0 and *SYMTAB is set to the symbol
4787 table in which the symbol was found (in both cases, these
4788 assignments occur only if the pointers are non-null). */
4789 struct symbol *
4790 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4791 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
4792 {
4793 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
4794 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
4795
4796 return
4797 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
4798 block0, namespace, NULL);
4799 }
4800
4801 static struct symbol *
4802 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
4803 const char *linkage_name,
4804 const struct block *block,
4805 const domain_enum domain)
4806 {
4807 if (linkage_name == NULL)
4808 linkage_name = name;
4809 return ada_lookup_symbol (linkage_name, block_static_block (block), domain,
4810 NULL);
4811 }
4812
4813
4814 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
4815 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
4816 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
4817 are given by any of the regular expressions:
4818
4819 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
4820 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
4821 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
4822 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
4823
4824 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
4825 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
4826 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
4827
4828 static int
4829 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
4830 {
4831 int k;
4832 const char *matching;
4833 const int len = strlen (str);
4834
4835 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
4836
4837 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
4838 {
4839 str += 3;
4840 while (isdigit (str[0]))
4841 str += 1;
4842 }
4843
4844 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
4845
4846 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
4847 {
4848 matching = str + 1;
4849 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4850 matching += 1;
4851 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4852 return 1;
4853 }
4854
4855 /* ___[0-9]+ */
4856
4857 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
4858 {
4859 matching = str + 3;
4860 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4861 matching += 1;
4862 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4863 return 1;
4864 }
4865
4866 #if 0
4867 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
4868 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
4869 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
4870 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
4871 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
4872 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
4873 name ends with N.
4874 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
4875 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
4876 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
4877 the following check. */
4878 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
4879 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
4880 return 1;
4881 #endif
4882
4883 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
4884 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
4885 {
4886 matching = str + 3;
4887 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4888 matching += 1;
4889 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
4890 && matching [1] == '\0')
4891 return 1;
4892 }
4893
4894 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
4895 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
4896 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
4897 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
4898 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
4899 if (str[0] == 'X')
4900 {
4901 str += 1;
4902 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
4903 {
4904 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
4905 return 0;
4906 str += 1;
4907 }
4908 }
4909
4910 if (str[0] == '\000')
4911 return 1;
4912
4913 if (str[0] == '_')
4914 {
4915 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
4916 return 0;
4917 if (str[2] == '_')
4918 {
4919 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
4920 return 1;
4921 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
4922 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
4923 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
4924 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
4925 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
4926 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
4927 return 1;
4928 if (str[3] != 'X')
4929 return 0;
4930 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
4931 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
4932 return 1;
4933 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
4934 return 1;
4935 return 0;
4936 }
4937 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
4938 return 0;
4939 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4940 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4941 return 0;
4942 return 1;
4943 }
4944 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
4945 {
4946 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4947 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4948 return 0;
4949 return 1;
4950 }
4951 return 0;
4952 }
4953
4954 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
4955 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
4956
4957 static int
4958 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
4959 {
4960 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
4961 int i;
4962
4963 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
4964 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
4965 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
4966 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
4967 return 0;
4968
4969 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
4970 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
4971 return 0;
4972
4973 return 1;
4974 }
4975
4976 /* True if NAME represents a name of the form A1.A2....An, n>=1 and
4977 PATN[0..PATN_LEN-1] = Ak.Ak+1.....An for some k >= 1. Ignores
4978 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
4979 true). */
4980
4981 static int
4982 wild_match (const char *patn0, int patn_len, const char *name0)
4983 {
4984 char* match;
4985 const char* start;
4986 start = name0;
4987 while (1)
4988 {
4989 match = strstr (start, patn0);
4990 if (match == NULL)
4991 return 0;
4992 if ((match == name0
4993 || match[-1] == '.'
4994 || (match > name0 + 1 && match[-1] == '_' && match[-2] == '_')
4995 || (match == name0 + 5 && strncmp ("_ada_", name0, 5) == 0))
4996 && is_name_suffix (match + patn_len))
4997 return (match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0));
4998 start = match + 1;
4999 }
5000 }
5001
5002
5003 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5004 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5005 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5006 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5007 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5008
5009 static void
5010 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5011 struct block *block, const char *name,
5012 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5013 int wild)
5014 {
5015 struct dict_iterator iter;
5016 int name_len = strlen (name);
5017 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5018 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5019 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5020 int found_sym;
5021 struct symbol *sym;
5022
5023 arg_sym = NULL;
5024 found_sym = 0;
5025 if (wild)
5026 {
5027 struct symbol *sym;
5028 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5029 {
5030 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5031 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5032 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)))
5033 {
5034 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5035 continue;
5036 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5037 arg_sym = sym;
5038 else
5039 {
5040 found_sym = 1;
5041 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5042 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5043 block);
5044 }
5045 }
5046 }
5047 }
5048 else
5049 {
5050 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5051 {
5052 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5053 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5054 {
5055 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name_len);
5056 if (cmp == 0
5057 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len))
5058 {
5059 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5060 {
5061 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5062 arg_sym = sym;
5063 else
5064 {
5065 found_sym = 1;
5066 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5067 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5068 block);
5069 }
5070 }
5071 }
5072 }
5073 }
5074 }
5075
5076 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5077 {
5078 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5079 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5080 block);
5081 }
5082
5083 if (!wild)
5084 {
5085 arg_sym = NULL;
5086 found_sym = 0;
5087
5088 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5089 {
5090 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5091 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5092 {
5093 int cmp;
5094
5095 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5096 if (cmp == 0)
5097 {
5098 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5099 if (cmp == 0)
5100 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5101 name_len);
5102 }
5103
5104 if (cmp == 0
5105 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5106 {
5107 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5108 {
5109 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5110 arg_sym = sym;
5111 else
5112 {
5113 found_sym = 1;
5114 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5115 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5116 block);
5117 }
5118 }
5119 }
5120 }
5121 }
5122
5123 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5124 They aren't parameters, right? */
5125 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5126 {
5127 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5128 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5129 block);
5130 }
5131 }
5132 }
5133 \f
5134
5135 /* Symbol Completion */
5136
5137 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5138 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5139 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5140
5141 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5142 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH is set.
5143 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5144 in its encoded form. */
5145
5146 static const char *
5147 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5148 const char *text, int text_len,
5149 int wild_match, int encoded)
5150 {
5151 char *result;
5152 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5153 int match = 0;
5154
5155 if (verbatim_match)
5156 {
5157 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5158 text = text + 1;
5159 text_len--;
5160 }
5161
5162 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5163
5164 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5165 match = 1;
5166
5167 if (match && !encoded)
5168 {
5169 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5170 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5171 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5172 is not a suitable completion. */
5173 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5174 int has_angle_bracket;
5175
5176 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5177 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5178 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5179 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5180 }
5181
5182 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5183 {
5184 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5185 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5186 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5187 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5188 angle bracket notation. */
5189 const char *tmp;
5190
5191 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5192 if (*tmp != '\0')
5193 match = 0;
5194 }
5195
5196 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5197
5198 if (!match && wild_match)
5199 {
5200 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5201 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5202 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5203 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5204
5205 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5206 match = 1;
5207 }
5208
5209 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5210
5211 if (!match)
5212 return NULL;
5213
5214 if (verbatim_match)
5215 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5216
5217 if (!encoded)
5218 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5219
5220 return sym_name;
5221 }
5222
5223 typedef char *char_ptr;
5224 DEF_VEC_P (char_ptr);
5225
5226 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5227 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5228 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5229 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5230
5231 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5232 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5233 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5234 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5235 completion vector.
5236 if WILD_MATCH is set, then wild matching is performed.
5237 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5238 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5239 encoded). */
5240
5241 static void
5242 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5243 const char *sym_name,
5244 const char *text, int text_len,
5245 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5246 int wild_match, int encoded)
5247 {
5248 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5249 wild_match, encoded);
5250 char *completion;
5251
5252 if (match == NULL)
5253 return;
5254
5255 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5256 string vector. */
5257
5258 if (word == orig_text)
5259 {
5260 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5261 strcpy (completion, match);
5262 }
5263 else if (word > orig_text)
5264 {
5265 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5266 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5267 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5268 }
5269 else
5270 {
5271 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5272 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5273 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5274 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5275 strcat (completion, match);
5276 }
5277
5278 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5279 }
5280
5281 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. The list
5282 is NULL terminated. WORD is the entire command on which completion
5283 is made. */
5284
5285 static char **
5286 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5287 {
5288 char *text;
5289 int text_len;
5290 int wild_match;
5291 int encoded;
5292 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5293 struct symbol *sym;
5294 struct symtab *s;
5295 struct partial_symtab *ps;
5296 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5297 struct objfile *objfile;
5298 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5299 int i;
5300 struct dict_iterator iter;
5301
5302 if (text0[0] == '<')
5303 {
5304 text = xstrdup (text0);
5305 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5306 text_len = strlen (text);
5307 wild_match = 0;
5308 encoded = 1;
5309 }
5310 else
5311 {
5312 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5313 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5314 text_len = strlen (text);
5315 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5316 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5317
5318 encoded = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5319 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5320 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5321 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5322 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5323 wild_match = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded);
5324 }
5325
5326 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5327 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
5328 {
5329 struct partial_symbol **psym;
5330
5331 /* If the psymtab's been read in we'll get it when we search
5332 through the blockvector. */
5333 if (ps->readin)
5334 continue;
5335
5336 for (psym = objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset;
5337 psym < (objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset
5338 + ps->n_global_syms); psym++)
5339 {
5340 QUIT;
5341 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5342 text, text_len, text0, word,
5343 wild_match, encoded);
5344 }
5345
5346 for (psym = objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset;
5347 psym < (objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset
5348 + ps->n_static_syms); psym++)
5349 {
5350 QUIT;
5351 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5352 text, text_len, text0, word,
5353 wild_match, encoded);
5354 }
5355 }
5356
5357 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5358 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5359 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5360 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5361
5362 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5363 {
5364 QUIT;
5365 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5366 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match, encoded);
5367 }
5368
5369 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5370 complete on local vars. */
5371
5372 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5373 {
5374 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5375 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5376
5377 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5378 {
5379 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5380 text, text_len, text0, word,
5381 wild_match, encoded);
5382 }
5383 }
5384
5385 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5386 symbols which match. */
5387
5388 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5389 {
5390 QUIT;
5391 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5392 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5393 {
5394 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5395 text, text_len, text0, word,
5396 wild_match, encoded);
5397 }
5398 }
5399
5400 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5401 {
5402 QUIT;
5403 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5404 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5405 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5406 continue;
5407 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5408 {
5409 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5410 text, text_len, text0, word,
5411 wild_match, encoded);
5412 }
5413 }
5414
5415 /* Append the closing NULL entry. */
5416 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, completions, NULL);
5417
5418 /* Make a copy of the COMPLETIONS VEC before we free it, and then
5419 return the copy. It's unfortunate that we have to make a copy
5420 of an array that we're about to destroy, but there is nothing much
5421 we can do about it. Fortunately, it's typically not a very large
5422 array. */
5423 {
5424 const size_t completions_size =
5425 VEC_length (char_ptr, completions) * sizeof (char *);
5426 char **result = malloc (completions_size);
5427
5428 memcpy (result, VEC_address (char_ptr, completions), completions_size);
5429
5430 VEC_free (char_ptr, completions);
5431 return result;
5432 }
5433 }
5434
5435 /* Field Access */
5436
5437 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5438 for tagged types. */
5439
5440 static int
5441 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5442 {
5443 char *name;
5444
5445 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5446 return 0;
5447
5448 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5449 if (name == NULL)
5450 return 0;
5451
5452 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5453 }
5454
5455 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5456 to be invisible to users. */
5457
5458 int
5459 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5460 {
5461 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5462 return 1;
5463
5464 /* Check the name of that field. */
5465 {
5466 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5467
5468 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5469 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5470 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5471 if (name == NULL)
5472 return 1;
5473
5474 /* A field named "_parent" is internally generated by GNAT for
5475 tagged types, and should not be printed either. */
5476 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5477 return 1;
5478 }
5479
5480 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5481 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5482 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5483 return 1;
5484
5485 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5486 return 0;
5487 }
5488
5489 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5490 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5491
5492 int
5493 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5494 {
5495 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5496 }
5497
5498 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5499
5500 int
5501 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5502 {
5503 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5504 return 0;
5505 else
5506 {
5507 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5508 return (name != NULL
5509 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5510 }
5511 }
5512
5513 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
5514
5515 struct type *
5516 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
5517 {
5518 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
5519 }
5520
5521 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
5522
5523 struct value *
5524 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
5525 {
5526 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
5527 }
5528
5529 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
5530 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
5531 ADDRESS. */
5532
5533 static struct value *
5534 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
5535 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
5536 CORE_ADDR address)
5537 {
5538 int tag_byte_offset, dummy1, dummy2;
5539 struct type *tag_type;
5540 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
5541 NULL, NULL, NULL))
5542 {
5543 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
5544 ? NULL
5545 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
5546 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
5547
5548 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
5549 }
5550 return NULL;
5551 }
5552
5553 static struct type *
5554 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
5555 {
5556 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
5557 if (type_name != NULL)
5558 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
5559 return NULL;
5560 }
5561
5562 struct tag_args
5563 {
5564 struct value *tag;
5565 char *name;
5566 };
5567
5568
5569 static int ada_tag_name_1 (void *);
5570 static int ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *);
5571
5572 /* Wrapper function used by ada_tag_name. Given a struct tag_args*
5573 value ARGS, sets ARGS->name to the tag name of ARGS->tag.
5574 The value stored in ARGS->name is valid until the next call to
5575 ada_tag_name_1. */
5576
5577 static int
5578 ada_tag_name_1 (void *args0)
5579 {
5580 struct tag_args *args = (struct tag_args *) args0;
5581 static char name[1024];
5582 char *p;
5583 struct value *val;
5584 args->name = NULL;
5585 val = ada_value_struct_elt (args->tag, "tsd", 1);
5586 if (val == NULL)
5587 return ada_tag_name_2 (args);
5588 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5589 if (val == NULL)
5590 return 0;
5591 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5592 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5593 if (isalpha (*p))
5594 *p = tolower (*p);
5595 args->name = name;
5596 return 0;
5597 }
5598
5599 /* Utility function for ada_tag_name_1 that tries the second
5600 representation for the dispatch table (in which there is no
5601 explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, and instead
5602 the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch table. */
5603
5604 static int
5605 ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *args)
5606 {
5607 struct type *info_type;
5608 static char name[1024];
5609 char *p;
5610 struct value *val, *valp;
5611
5612 args->name = NULL;
5613 info_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
5614 if (info_type == NULL)
5615 return 0;
5616 info_type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (info_type));
5617 valp = value_cast (info_type, args->tag);
5618 if (valp == NULL)
5619 return 0;
5620 val = value_ind (value_ptradd (valp,
5621 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int8, -1)));
5622 if (val == NULL)
5623 return 0;
5624 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5625 if (val == NULL)
5626 return 0;
5627 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5628 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5629 if (isalpha (*p))
5630 *p = tolower (*p);
5631 args->name = name;
5632 return 0;
5633 }
5634
5635 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
5636 * a C string. */
5637
5638 const char *
5639 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
5640 {
5641 struct tag_args args;
5642 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
5643 return NULL;
5644 args.tag = tag;
5645 args.name = NULL;
5646 catch_errors (ada_tag_name_1, &args, NULL, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5647 return args.name;
5648 }
5649
5650 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
5651
5652 struct type *
5653 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
5654 {
5655 int i;
5656
5657 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5658
5659 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
5660 return NULL;
5661
5662 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5663 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
5664 {
5665 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5666
5667 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
5668 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5669 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
5670 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
5671 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
5672
5673 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
5674 }
5675
5676 return NULL;
5677 }
5678
5679 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
5680 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
5681 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5682
5683 int
5684 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5685 {
5686 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
5687 return (name != NULL
5688 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5689 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
5690 }
5691
5692 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
5693 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
5694 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
5695 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
5696 structures. */
5697
5698 int
5699 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5700 {
5701 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5702 return (name != NULL
5703 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5704 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
5705 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
5706 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
5707 }
5708
5709 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
5710 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
5711 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5712
5713 int
5714 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
5715 {
5716 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
5717 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
5718 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
5719 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
5720 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
5721 }
5722
5723 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
5724 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
5725 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant. */
5726
5727 struct type *
5728 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
5729 {
5730 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
5731 struct type *type =
5732 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
5733 if (type == NULL)
5734 return builtin_type_int32;
5735 else
5736 return type;
5737 }
5738
5739 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
5740 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
5741 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
5742
5743 int
5744 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
5745 {
5746 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5747 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
5748 }
5749
5750 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
5751 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
5752 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
5753
5754 char *
5755 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
5756 {
5757 static char *result = NULL;
5758 static size_t result_len = 0;
5759 struct type *type;
5760 const char *name;
5761 const char *discrim_end;
5762 const char *discrim_start;
5763
5764 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5765 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
5766 else
5767 type = type0;
5768
5769 name = ada_type_name (type);
5770
5771 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
5772 return "";
5773
5774 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
5775 discrim_end -= 1)
5776 {
5777 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
5778 break;
5779 }
5780 if (discrim_end == name)
5781 return "";
5782
5783 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
5784 discrim_start -= 1)
5785 {
5786 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
5787 return "";
5788 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
5789 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
5790 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
5791 break;
5792 }
5793
5794 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
5795 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
5796 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
5797 return result;
5798 }
5799
5800 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
5801 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
5802 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
5803 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
5804 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
5805 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
5806 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
5807
5808 int
5809 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
5810 {
5811 ULONGEST RU;
5812
5813 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
5814 return 0;
5815
5816 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
5817 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
5818 LONGEST. */
5819 RU = 0;
5820 while (isdigit (str[k]))
5821 {
5822 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
5823 k += 1;
5824 }
5825
5826 if (str[k] == 'm')
5827 {
5828 if (R != NULL)
5829 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
5830 k += 1;
5831 }
5832 else if (R != NULL)
5833 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
5834
5835 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
5836 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
5837 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
5838 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
5839 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
5840
5841 if (new_k != NULL)
5842 *new_k = k;
5843 return 1;
5844 }
5845
5846 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
5847 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
5848 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
5849
5850 int
5851 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
5852 {
5853 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5854 int p;
5855
5856 p = 0;
5857 while (1)
5858 {
5859 switch (name[p])
5860 {
5861 case '\0':
5862 return 0;
5863 case 'S':
5864 {
5865 LONGEST W;
5866 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
5867 return 0;
5868 if (val == W)
5869 return 1;
5870 break;
5871 }
5872 case 'R':
5873 {
5874 LONGEST L, U;
5875 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
5876 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
5877 return 0;
5878 if (val >= L && val <= U)
5879 return 1;
5880 break;
5881 }
5882 case 'O':
5883 return 1;
5884 default:
5885 return 0;
5886 }
5887 }
5888 }
5889
5890 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
5891
5892 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
5893 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
5894 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
5895 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
5896
5897 static struct value *
5898 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
5899 struct type *arg_type)
5900 {
5901 struct type *type;
5902
5903 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
5904 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
5905
5906 /* Handle packed fields. */
5907
5908 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
5909 {
5910 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
5911 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
5912
5913 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
5914 offset + bit_pos / 8,
5915 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
5916 }
5917 else
5918 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
5919 }
5920
5921 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
5922 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
5923 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
5924 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
5925 an object of that type;
5926 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
5927 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
5928 0 otherwise;
5929 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
5930 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
5931 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
5932 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
5933
5934 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
5935
5936 static int
5937 find_struct_field (char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
5938 struct type **field_type_p,
5939 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
5940 int *index_p)
5941 {
5942 int i;
5943
5944 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5945
5946 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5947 *field_type_p = NULL;
5948 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5949 *byte_offset_p = 0;
5950 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5951 *bit_offset_p = 0;
5952 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5953 *bit_size_p = 0;
5954
5955 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5956 {
5957 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
5958 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
5959 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
5960
5961 if (t_field_name == NULL)
5962 continue;
5963
5964 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
5965 {
5966 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
5967 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5968 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5969 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5970 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
5971 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5972 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
5973 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5974 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
5975 return 1;
5976 }
5977 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
5978 {
5979 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
5980 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
5981 bit_size_p, index_p))
5982 return 1;
5983 }
5984 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
5985 {
5986 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
5987 fixed type?? */
5988 int j;
5989 struct type *field_type
5990 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
5991
5992 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
5993 {
5994 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
5995 fld_offset
5996 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
5997 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
5998 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
5999 return 1;
6000 }
6001 }
6002 else if (index_p != NULL)
6003 *index_p += 1;
6004 }
6005 return 0;
6006 }
6007
6008 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6009
6010 static int
6011 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6012 {
6013 int n;
6014 n = 0;
6015 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6016 return n;
6017 }
6018
6019 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6020 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6021 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6022
6023 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6024
6025 static struct value *
6026 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6027 struct type *type)
6028 {
6029 int i;
6030 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6031
6032 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6033 {
6034 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6035
6036 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6037 continue;
6038
6039 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6040 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6041
6042 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6043 {
6044 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6045 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6046 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6047 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6048 if (v != NULL)
6049 return v;
6050 }
6051
6052 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6053 {
6054 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6055 int j;
6056 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6057 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6058
6059 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6060 {
6061 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line break. */
6062 (name, arg,
6063 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6064 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6065 if (v != NULL)
6066 return v;
6067 }
6068 }
6069 }
6070 return NULL;
6071 }
6072
6073 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6074 int, struct type *);
6075
6076
6077 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6078 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6079 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6080 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6081
6082 static struct value *
6083 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6084 struct type *type)
6085 {
6086 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6087 }
6088
6089
6090 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6091 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6092 * *INDEX_P. */
6093
6094 static struct value *
6095 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6096 struct type *type)
6097 {
6098 int i;
6099 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6100
6101 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6102 {
6103 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6104 continue;
6105 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6106 {
6107 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6108 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6109 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6110 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6111 if (v != NULL)
6112 return v;
6113 }
6114
6115 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6116 {
6117 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6118 find_struct_field. */
6119 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6120 }
6121 else if (*index_p == 0)
6122 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6123 else
6124 *index_p -= 1;
6125 }
6126 return NULL;
6127 }
6128
6129 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6130 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6131 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6132 appropriate type.
6133
6134 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6135 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6136 (e.g., '_parent').
6137
6138 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6139 calling error. */
6140
6141 struct value *
6142 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6143 {
6144 struct type *t, *t1;
6145 struct value *v;
6146
6147 v = NULL;
6148 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6149 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6150 {
6151 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6152 if (t1 == NULL)
6153 goto BadValue;
6154 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6155 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6156 {
6157 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6158 t = t1;
6159 }
6160 }
6161
6162 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6163 {
6164 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6165 if (t1 == NULL)
6166 goto BadValue;
6167 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6168 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6169 {
6170 arg = value_ind (arg);
6171 t = t1;
6172 }
6173 else
6174 break;
6175 }
6176
6177 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6178 goto BadValue;
6179
6180 if (t1 == t)
6181 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6182 else
6183 {
6184 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6185 struct type *field_type;
6186 CORE_ADDR address;
6187
6188 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6189 address = value_as_address (arg);
6190 else
6191 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6192
6193 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6194 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6195 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6196 &bit_size, NULL))
6197 {
6198 if (bit_size != 0)
6199 {
6200 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6201 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6202 else
6203 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6204 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6205 bit_offset, bit_size,
6206 field_type);
6207 }
6208 else
6209 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6210 }
6211 }
6212
6213 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6214 return v;
6215 else
6216 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6217
6218 BadValue:
6219 if (no_err)
6220 return NULL;
6221 else
6222 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of a value that is not a record."));
6223 }
6224
6225 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6226 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6227 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6228 work for packed fields).
6229
6230 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6231 followed by "___".
6232
6233 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6234 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6235 ultimate target type will be searched.
6236
6237 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6238
6239 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6240 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6241
6242 static struct type *
6243 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6244 int noerr, int *dispp)
6245 {
6246 int i;
6247
6248 if (name == NULL)
6249 goto BadName;
6250
6251 if (refok && type != NULL)
6252 while (1)
6253 {
6254 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6255 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6256 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6257 break;
6258 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6259 }
6260
6261 if (type == NULL
6262 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6263 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6264 {
6265 if (noerr)
6266 return NULL;
6267 else
6268 {
6269 target_terminal_ours ();
6270 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6271 if (type == NULL)
6272 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6273 else
6274 {
6275 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6276 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6277 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6278 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6279 }
6280 }
6281 }
6282
6283 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6284
6285 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6286 {
6287 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6288 struct type *t;
6289 int disp;
6290
6291 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6292 continue;
6293
6294 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6295 {
6296 if (dispp != NULL)
6297 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6298 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6299 }
6300
6301 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6302 {
6303 disp = 0;
6304 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6305 0, 1, &disp);
6306 if (t != NULL)
6307 {
6308 if (dispp != NULL)
6309 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6310 return t;
6311 }
6312 }
6313
6314 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6315 {
6316 int j;
6317 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6318
6319 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6320 {
6321 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
6322 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
6323 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
6324 if the compiler changes this practice. */
6325 char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
6326 disp = 0;
6327 if (v_field_name != NULL
6328 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
6329 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6330 else
6331 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6332 name, 0, 1, &disp);
6333
6334 if (t != NULL)
6335 {
6336 if (dispp != NULL)
6337 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6338 return t;
6339 }
6340 }
6341 }
6342
6343 }
6344
6345 BadName:
6346 if (!noerr)
6347 {
6348 target_terminal_ours ();
6349 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6350 if (name == NULL)
6351 {
6352 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6353 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6354 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6355 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6356 }
6357 else
6358 {
6359 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6360 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6361 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6362 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6363 }
6364 }
6365
6366 return NULL;
6367 }
6368
6369 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6370 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
6371 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
6372 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
6373
6374 static int
6375 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6376 {
6377 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6378 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
6379 == NULL);
6380 }
6381
6382
6383 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6384 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6385 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6386 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6387
6388 int
6389 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6390 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6391 {
6392 int others_clause;
6393 int i;
6394 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6395 struct value *outer;
6396 struct value *discrim;
6397 LONGEST discrim_val;
6398
6399 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6400 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6401 if (discrim == NULL)
6402 return -1;
6403 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6404
6405 others_clause = -1;
6406 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6407 {
6408 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6409 others_clause = i;
6410 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6411 return i;
6412 }
6413
6414 return others_clause;
6415 }
6416 \f
6417
6418
6419 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6420
6421 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6422 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6423 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6424 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6425 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6426
6427 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6428 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6429 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6430 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6431 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6432 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6433 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6434 rather than struct value*s.
6435
6436 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6437 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6438 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6439 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6440 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6441 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6442 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6443 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6444 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6445 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6446 element selected. */
6447
6448 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6449 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6450 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6451 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6452 target at the target address. */
6453
6454 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6455 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6456 dynamic-sized types. */
6457
6458 struct value *
6459 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6460 {
6461 struct value *val = unwrap_value (value_ind (val0));
6462 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6463 }
6464
6465 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6466 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6467
6468 static struct value *
6469 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6470 {
6471 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6472 {
6473 struct value *val = val0;
6474 val = coerce_ref (val);
6475 val = unwrap_value (val);
6476 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6477 }
6478 else
6479 return val0;
6480 }
6481
6482 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
6483 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
6484
6485 static unsigned int
6486 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
6487 {
6488 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
6492
6493 static unsigned int
6494 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
6495 {
6496 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6497 int len;
6498 int align_offset;
6499
6500 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
6501 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
6502 require any alignment. */
6503 if (name == NULL)
6504 return 1;
6505
6506 len = strlen (name);
6507
6508 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
6509 return 1;
6510
6511 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
6512 align_offset = len - 2;
6513 else
6514 align_offset = len - 1;
6515
6516 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
6517 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6518
6519 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6520 }
6521
6522 /* Find a symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6523
6524 struct symbol *
6525 ada_find_any_symbol (const char *name)
6526 {
6527 struct symbol *sym;
6528
6529 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
6530 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
6531 return sym;
6532
6533 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
6534 return sym;
6535 }
6536
6537 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6538
6539 struct type *
6540 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
6541 {
6542 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6543 struct type *type = NULL;
6544
6545 if (sym != NULL)
6546 type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
6547
6548 if (type == NULL)
6549 type = language_lookup_primitive_type_by_name
6550 (language_def (language_ada), current_gdbarch, name);
6551
6552 return type;
6553 }
6554
6555 /* Given NAME and an associated BLOCK, search all symbols for
6556 NAME suffixed with "___XR", which is the ``renaming'' symbol
6557 associated to NAME. Return this symbol if found, return
6558 NULL otherwise. */
6559
6560 struct symbol *
6561 ada_find_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6562 {
6563 struct symbol *sym;
6564
6565 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
6566
6567 if (sym != NULL)
6568 return sym;
6569
6570 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
6571 sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6572 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
6573 return sym;
6574 else
6575 return NULL;
6576 }
6577
6578 static struct symbol *
6579 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6580 {
6581 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
6582 char *rename;
6583
6584 if (function_sym != NULL)
6585 {
6586 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
6587 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
6588 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
6589 the associated renaming symbol. */
6590 char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
6591 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
6592 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
6593 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
6594 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
6595 name length below. */
6596 const int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
6597 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
6598 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
6599
6600 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
6601 function_name[function_name_len] = '\0';
6602
6603 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
6604 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
6605 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
6606 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
6607 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
6608 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
6609 function_name = function_name + 5;
6610
6611 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6612 sprintf (rename, "%s__%s___XR", function_name, name);
6613 }
6614 else
6615 {
6616 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
6617 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6618 sprintf (rename, "%s___XR", name);
6619 }
6620
6621 return ada_find_any_symbol (rename);
6622 }
6623
6624 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
6625 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
6626 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
6627 otherwise return 0. */
6628
6629 int
6630 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
6631 {
6632 if (type1 == NULL)
6633 return 1;
6634 else if (type0 == NULL)
6635 return 0;
6636 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6637 return 1;
6638 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6639 return 0;
6640 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
6641 return 1;
6642 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type0))
6643 return 1;
6644 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
6645 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
6646 return 1;
6647 else
6648 {
6649 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
6650 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
6651
6652 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
6653 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
6654 return 1;
6655 }
6656 return 0;
6657 }
6658
6659 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
6660 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
6661
6662 char *
6663 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
6664 {
6665 if (type == NULL)
6666 return NULL;
6667 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
6668 return TYPE_NAME (type);
6669 else
6670 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
6671 }
6672
6673 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE whose name is formed by appending
6674 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
6675
6676 struct type *
6677 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
6678 {
6679 static char *name;
6680 static size_t name_len = 0;
6681 int len;
6682 char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
6683
6684 if (typename == NULL)
6685 return NULL;
6686
6687 len = strlen (typename);
6688
6689 GROW_VECT (name, name_len, len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
6690
6691 strcpy (name, typename);
6692 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
6693
6694 return ada_find_any_type (name);
6695 }
6696
6697
6698 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
6699 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
6700
6701 static struct type *
6702 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
6703 {
6704 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6705
6706 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6707 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
6708 return NULL;
6709 else
6710 {
6711 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
6712 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
6713 return type;
6714 else
6715 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
6716 }
6717 }
6718
6719 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
6720 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
6721
6722 static int
6723 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
6724 {
6725 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
6726 return name != NULL
6727 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6728 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
6729 }
6730
6731 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
6732 represent a variant record type. */
6733
6734 static int
6735 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
6736 {
6737 int f;
6738
6739 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6740 return -1;
6741
6742 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
6743 {
6744 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6745 return f;
6746 }
6747 return -1;
6748 }
6749
6750 /* A record type with no fields. */
6751
6752 static struct type *
6753 empty_record (struct objfile *objfile)
6754 {
6755 struct type *type = alloc_type (objfile);
6756 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6757 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
6758 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
6759 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
6760 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
6761 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
6762 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
6763 return type;
6764 }
6765
6766 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
6767 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
6768 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
6769 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
6770 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
6771 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
6772 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
6773 of the variant.
6774
6775 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
6776 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
6777 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
6778
6779 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
6780 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
6781 byte-aligned. */
6782
6783 struct type *
6784 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
6785 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6786 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
6787 int keep_dynamic_fields)
6788 {
6789 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
6790 struct value *dval;
6791 struct type *rtype;
6792 int nfields, bit_len;
6793 int variant_field;
6794 long off;
6795 int fld_bit_len, bit_incr;
6796 int f;
6797
6798 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
6799 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
6800 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
6801 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
6802 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
6803 else
6804 {
6805 nfields = 0;
6806 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
6807 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
6808 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
6809 nfields++;
6810 }
6811
6812 rtype = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
6813 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6814 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
6815 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
6816 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
6817 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
6818 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
6819 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
6820 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
6821 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
6822
6823 off = 0;
6824 bit_len = 0;
6825 variant_field = -1;
6826
6827 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
6828 {
6829 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
6830 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
6831 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, f) = off;
6832 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
6833
6834 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6835 {
6836 variant_field = f;
6837 fld_bit_len = bit_incr = 0;
6838 }
6839 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
6840 {
6841 if (dval0 == NULL)
6842 {
6843 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
6844 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
6845 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
6846 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
6847 size first before creating the value. */
6848 check_size (rtype);
6849 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6850 }
6851 else
6852 dval = dval0;
6853
6854 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case, we
6855 do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if the current
6856 field is the parent part of a tagged record, we will get the
6857 tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real type of the parent
6858 is not the real type of the child. We would end up in an infinite
6859 loop. */
6860 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) =
6861 ada_to_fixed_type
6862 (ada_get_base_type
6863 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f))),
6864 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
6865 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval, 0);
6866 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6867 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6868 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6869 }
6870 else
6871 {
6872 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
6873 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6874 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
6875 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6876 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
6877 else
6878 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6879 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6880 }
6881 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6882 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6883 off += bit_incr;
6884 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6885 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6886 }
6887
6888 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
6889 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
6890 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
6891 clauses. */
6892 if (variant_field >= 0)
6893 {
6894 struct type *branch_type;
6895
6896 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
6897
6898 if (dval0 == NULL)
6899 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6900 else
6901 dval = dval0;
6902
6903 branch_type =
6904 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
6905 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
6906 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
6907 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
6908 if (branch_type == NULL)
6909 {
6910 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
6911 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
6912 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
6913 }
6914 else
6915 {
6916 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
6917 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
6918 fld_bit_len =
6919 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
6920 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6921 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6922 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6923 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6924 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6925 }
6926 }
6927
6928 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
6929 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
6930 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
6931 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
6932 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
6933 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
6934 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
6935 {
6936 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
6937 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
6938 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6939 else
6940 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
6941 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6942 }
6943 else
6944 {
6945 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
6946 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6947 }
6948
6949 value_free_to_mark (mark);
6950 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
6951 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
6952 return rtype;
6953 }
6954
6955 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
6956 of 1. */
6957
6958 static struct type *
6959 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6960 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
6961 {
6962 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
6963 address, dval0, 1);
6964 }
6965
6966 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
6967 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
6968 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
6969 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
6970 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
6971 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
6972 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
6973 template type. */
6974
6975 static struct type *
6976 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
6977 {
6978 struct type *type;
6979 int nfields;
6980 int f;
6981
6982 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
6983 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6984
6985 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
6986 type = type0;
6987
6988 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
6989 {
6990 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
6991 struct type *new_type;
6992
6993 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
6994 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
6995 else
6996 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
6997 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
6998 {
6999 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0));
7000 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7001 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7002 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7003 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7004 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7005 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7006 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7007 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7008 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7009 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7010 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7011 }
7012 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7013 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7014 }
7015 return type;
7016 }
7017
7018 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7019 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7020 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7021 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7022 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7023 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7024
7025 static struct type *
7026 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7027 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7028 {
7029 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7030 struct value *dval;
7031 struct type *rtype;
7032 struct type *branch_type;
7033 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7034 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7035
7036 if (variant_field == -1)
7037 return type;
7038
7039 if (dval0 == NULL)
7040 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7041 else
7042 dval = dval0;
7043
7044 rtype = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
7045 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7046 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7047 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7048 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7049 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7050 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7051 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7052 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7053 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7054 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7055 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7056
7057 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7058 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7059 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7060 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7061 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7062 cond_offset_target (address,
7063 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7064 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7065 if (branch_type == NULL)
7066 {
7067 int f;
7068 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7069 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7070 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7071 }
7072 else
7073 {
7074 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7075 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7076 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7077 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7078 }
7079 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7080
7081 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7082 return rtype;
7083 }
7084
7085 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7086 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7087 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7088 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7089 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7090 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7091 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7092 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7093 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7094
7095 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7096 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7097 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7098 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7099 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7100 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7101 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7102
7103 static struct type *
7104 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7105 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7106 {
7107 struct type *templ_type;
7108
7109 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7110 return type0;
7111
7112 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7113
7114 if (templ_type != NULL)
7115 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7116 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7117 {
7118 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7119 return type0;
7120 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7121 dval);
7122 }
7123 else
7124 {
7125 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
7126 return type0;
7127 }
7128
7129 }
7130
7131 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7132 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7133 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7134 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7135 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7136 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
7137 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
7138
7139 static struct type *
7140 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7141 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7142 {
7143 int which;
7144 struct type *templ_type;
7145 struct type *var_type;
7146
7147 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7148 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7149 else
7150 var_type = var_type0;
7151
7152 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7153
7154 if (templ_type != NULL)
7155 var_type = templ_type;
7156
7157 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
7158 return var_type0;
7159 which =
7160 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7161 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7162
7163 if (which < 0)
7164 return empty_record (TYPE_OBJFILE (var_type));
7165 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7166 return to_fixed_record_type
7167 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7168 valaddr, address, dval);
7169 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7170 return
7171 to_fixed_record_type
7172 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7173 else
7174 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7175 }
7176
7177 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7178 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7179 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7180 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7181 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7182 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7183 varsize_limit. */
7184
7185 static struct type *
7186 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7187 int ignore_too_big)
7188 {
7189 struct type *index_type_desc;
7190 struct type *result;
7191
7192 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type0) /* revisit? */
7193 || TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7194 return type0;
7195
7196 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7197 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7198 {
7199 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7200 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7201 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7202 debugging data. */
7203 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7204 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7205 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7206 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7207 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7208 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7209 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7210 consult the object tag. */
7211 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7212
7213 if (elt_type0 == elt_type)
7214 result = type0;
7215 else
7216 result = create_array_type (alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0)),
7217 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7218 }
7219 else
7220 {
7221 int i;
7222 struct type *elt_type0;
7223
7224 elt_type0 = type0;
7225 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7226 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7227
7228 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7229 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7230 debugging data. */
7231 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7232 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7233 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7234 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7235 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7236 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7237 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7238 consult the object tag. */
7239 result =
7240 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7241 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7242 {
7243 struct type *range_type =
7244 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, i),
7245 dval, TYPE_OBJFILE (type0));
7246 result = create_array_type (alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0)),
7247 result, range_type);
7248 }
7249 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7250 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7251 }
7252
7253 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
7254 return result;
7255 }
7256
7257
7258 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7259 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7260 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7261 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7262 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7263
7264 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7265 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7266 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7267 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7268 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7269
7270 static struct type *
7271 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7272 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7273 {
7274 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7275 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7276 {
7277 default:
7278 return type;
7279 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7280 {
7281 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7282 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7283 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7284 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7285 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7286 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7287 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7288 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7289 them). */
7290
7291 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7292 {
7293 struct type *real_type =
7294 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7295 (fixed_record_type,
7296 valaddr,
7297 address));
7298 if (real_type != NULL)
7299 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7300 }
7301
7302 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
7303 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
7304 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
7305 {
7306 char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
7307 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
7308 int xvz_found = 0;
7309 LONGEST size;
7310
7311 sprintf (xvz_name, "%s___XVZ", name);
7312 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
7313 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
7314 {
7315 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
7316 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
7317
7318 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
7319 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
7320 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
7321
7322 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
7323 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
7324 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
7325 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
7326 definition.
7327
7328 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
7329 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
7330 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
7331 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
7332 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
7333 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
7334 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
7335 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
7336 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
7337 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
7338 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
7339 }
7340 }
7341 return fixed_record_type;
7342 }
7343 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
7344 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
7345 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7346 if (dval == NULL)
7347 return type;
7348 else
7349 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
7350 }
7351 }
7352
7353 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
7354 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
7355 ada_to_fixed_type_1 would return the type referenced by TYPE. */
7356
7357 struct type *
7358 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7359 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7360
7361 {
7362 struct type *fixed_type =
7363 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
7364
7365 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
7366 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == fixed_type)
7367 return type;
7368
7369 return fixed_type;
7370 }
7371
7372 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
7373 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
7374
7375 static struct type *
7376 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7377 {
7378 struct type *type;
7379
7380 if (type0 == NULL)
7381 return NULL;
7382
7383 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7384 return type0;
7385
7386 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7387
7388 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
7389 {
7390 default:
7391 return type0;
7392 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7393 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7394 if (type != NULL)
7395 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7396 else
7397 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7398 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7399 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
7400 if (type != NULL)
7401 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7402 else
7403 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7404 }
7405 }
7406
7407 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
7408
7409 static struct type *
7410 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
7411 {
7412 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7413 {
7414 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
7415 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
7416 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
7417
7418 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
7419 }
7420 else
7421 {
7422 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
7423 if (raw_real_type == type)
7424 return type;
7425 else
7426 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
7427 }
7428 }
7429
7430 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
7431 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
7432 type Foo;
7433 type FooP is access Foo;
7434 V: FooP;
7435 type Foo is array ...;
7436 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
7437 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
7438 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
7439 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
7440
7441 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
7442 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
7443
7444 struct type *
7445 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
7446 {
7447 if (type == NULL)
7448 return NULL;
7449
7450 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
7451 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
7452 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
7453 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
7454 return type;
7455 else
7456 {
7457 char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7458 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
7459 return (type1 == NULL) ? type : type1;
7460 }
7461 }
7462
7463 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
7464 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
7465 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
7466 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
7467 creation of struct values]. */
7468
7469 static struct value *
7470 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
7471 struct value *val0)
7472 {
7473 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
7474 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
7475 return val0;
7476 else
7477 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
7478 }
7479
7480 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7481 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
7482 value. */
7483
7484 static struct value *
7485 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7486 {
7487 return ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
7488 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val),
7489 val);
7490 }
7491
7492 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7493 chosen to approximate the real type of VAL as well as possible, but
7494 without consulting any runtime values. For Ada dynamic-sized
7495 types, therefore, the type of the result is likely to be inaccurate. */
7496
7497 static struct value *
7498 ada_to_static_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7499 {
7500 struct type *type =
7501 to_static_fixed_type (static_unwrap_type (value_type (val)));
7502 if (type == value_type (val))
7503 return val;
7504 else
7505 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (val, type);
7506 }
7507 \f
7508
7509 /* Attributes */
7510
7511 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
7512 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
7513
7514 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
7515 "<?>",
7516
7517 "first",
7518 "last",
7519 "length",
7520 "image",
7521 "max",
7522 "min",
7523 "modulus",
7524 "pos",
7525 "size",
7526 "tag",
7527 "val",
7528 0
7529 };
7530
7531 const char *
7532 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
7533 {
7534 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
7535 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
7536 else
7537 return attribute_names[0];
7538 }
7539
7540 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
7541
7542 static LONGEST
7543 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
7544 {
7545 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
7546 struct type *type = value_type (val);
7547
7548 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7549 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
7550
7551 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7552 {
7553 int i;
7554 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
7555
7556 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7557 {
7558 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i))
7559 return i;
7560 }
7561 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
7562 }
7563 else
7564 return value_as_long (val);
7565 }
7566
7567 static struct value *
7568 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7569 {
7570 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
7571 }
7572
7573 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
7574
7575 static struct value *
7576 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7577 {
7578 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7579 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
7580 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
7581 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
7582
7583 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7584 {
7585 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
7586 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
7587 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
7588 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, pos));
7589 }
7590 else
7591 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
7592 }
7593 \f
7594
7595 /* Evaluation */
7596
7597 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
7598 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
7599 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
7600
7601 int
7602 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
7603 {
7604 const char *name;
7605
7606 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
7607 and don't check any further. */
7608 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
7609 return 1;
7610
7611 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
7612 with a known character type name. */
7613 name = ada_type_name (type);
7614 return (name != NULL
7615 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
7616 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
7617 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
7618 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
7619 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
7620 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
7621 }
7622
7623 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
7624
7625 int
7626 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
7627 {
7628 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7629 if (type != NULL
7630 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7631 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
7632 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
7633 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
7634 {
7635 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
7636
7637 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
7638 }
7639 else
7640 return 0;
7641 }
7642
7643
7644 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
7645 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
7646 distinctive name. */
7647
7648 int
7649 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
7650 {
7651 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7652
7653 /* If we can find a parallel XVS type, then the XVS type should
7654 be used instead of this type. And hence, this is not an aligner
7655 type. */
7656 if (ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
7657 return 0;
7658
7659 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7660 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
7661 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
7662 }
7663
7664 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
7665 the parallel type. */
7666
7667 struct type *
7668 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
7669 {
7670 struct type *real_type_namer;
7671 struct type *raw_real_type;
7672
7673 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7674 return raw_type;
7675
7676 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
7677 if (real_type_namer == NULL
7678 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7679 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
7680 return raw_type;
7681
7682 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
7683 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
7684 return raw_type;
7685 else
7686 return raw_real_type;
7687 }
7688
7689 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
7690
7691 struct type *
7692 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
7693 {
7694 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7695 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
7696 else
7697 return ada_get_base_type (type);
7698 }
7699
7700
7701 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
7702 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
7703
7704 const gdb_byte *
7705 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
7706 {
7707 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7708 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
7709 valaddr +
7710 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
7711 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7712 else
7713 return valaddr;
7714 }
7715
7716
7717
7718 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
7719 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
7720 const char *
7721 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
7722 {
7723 static char *result;
7724 static size_t result_len = 0;
7725 char *tmp;
7726
7727 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
7728 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
7729 all the preceeding characters, the unqualified name starts
7730 right after that dot.
7731 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
7732 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
7733 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
7734 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
7735
7736 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
7737 if (tmp != NULL)
7738 name = tmp + 1;
7739 else
7740 {
7741 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
7742 {
7743 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
7744 break;
7745 else
7746 name = tmp + 2;
7747 }
7748 }
7749
7750 if (name[0] == 'Q')
7751 {
7752 int v;
7753 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
7754 {
7755 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
7756 return name;
7757 }
7758 else
7759 return name;
7760
7761 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
7762 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
7763 sprintf (result, "'%c'", v);
7764 else if (name[1] == 'U')
7765 sprintf (result, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
7766 else
7767 sprintf (result, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
7768
7769 return result;
7770 }
7771 else
7772 {
7773 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
7774 if (tmp == NULL)
7775 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
7776 if (tmp != NULL)
7777 {
7778 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
7779 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
7780 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
7781 return result;
7782 }
7783
7784 return name;
7785 }
7786 }
7787
7788 static struct value *
7789 evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp, int *pos,
7790 enum noside noside)
7791 {
7792 return (*exp->language_defn->la_exp_desc->evaluate_exp)
7793 (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
7794 }
7795
7796 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
7797 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
7798 expression. */
7799
7800 static struct value *
7801 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
7802 {
7803 return (*exp->language_defn->la_exp_desc->evaluate_exp)
7804 (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
7805 }
7806
7807 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
7808 value it wraps. */
7809
7810 static struct value *
7811 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
7812 {
7813 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
7814 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7815 {
7816 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
7817 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
7818 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
7819 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
7820
7821 return unwrap_value (v);
7822 }
7823 else
7824 {
7825 struct type *raw_real_type =
7826 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
7827
7828 if (type == raw_real_type)
7829 return val;
7830
7831 return
7832 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
7833 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
7834 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val),
7835 NULL, 1));
7836 }
7837 }
7838
7839 static struct value *
7840 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7841 {
7842 LONGEST val;
7843
7844 if (type == value_type (arg))
7845 return arg;
7846 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
7847 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
7848 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7849 value_as_long (arg)));
7850 else
7851 {
7852 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
7853 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
7854 }
7855
7856 return value_from_longest (type, val);
7857 }
7858
7859 static struct value *
7860 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7861 {
7862 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7863 value_as_long (arg));
7864 return value_from_double (type, val);
7865 }
7866
7867 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
7868 return the converted value. */
7869
7870 static struct value *
7871 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
7872 {
7873 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
7874 if (type == type2)
7875 return val;
7876
7877 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
7878 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7879
7880 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7881 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7882 {
7883 val = ada_value_ind (val);
7884 type2 = value_type (val);
7885 }
7886
7887 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
7888 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7889 {
7890 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
7891 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
7892 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
7893 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
7894 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
7895 }
7896 return val;
7897 }
7898
7899 static struct value *
7900 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
7901 {
7902 struct value *val;
7903 struct type *type1, *type2;
7904 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
7905
7906 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
7907 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
7908 type1 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
7909 type2 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
7910
7911 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
7912 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
7913 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7914
7915 switch (op)
7916 {
7917 case BINOP_MOD:
7918 case BINOP_DIV:
7919 case BINOP_REM:
7920 break;
7921 default:
7922 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7923 }
7924
7925 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
7926 if (v2 == 0)
7927 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
7928
7929 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
7930 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7931
7932 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
7933 switch (op)
7934 {
7935 case BINOP_DIV:
7936 v = v1 / v2;
7937 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
7938 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
7939 break;
7940 case BINOP_REM:
7941 v = v1 % v2;
7942 if (v * v1 < 0)
7943 v -= v2;
7944 break;
7945 default:
7946 /* Should not reach this point. */
7947 v = 0;
7948 }
7949
7950 val = allocate_value (type1);
7951 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
7952 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)), v);
7953 return val;
7954 }
7955
7956 static int
7957 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
7958 {
7959 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
7960 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
7961 {
7962 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
7963 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
7964 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
7965 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
7966
7967 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
7968 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
7969 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
7970 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7971 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
7972 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
7973 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
7974 and do not have user-defined equality. */
7975 return
7976 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
7977 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
7978 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
7979 }
7980 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
7981 }
7982
7983 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
7984 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
7985 OP_AGGREGATE. */
7986
7987 static int
7988 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
7989 {
7990 int n, m, i;
7991 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
7992 pc += 3;
7993 n = 0;
7994 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
7995 {
7996 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
7997 {
7998 default:
7999 n += 1;
8000 break;
8001 case OP_CHOICES:
8002 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8003 break;
8004 }
8005 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8006 }
8007 return n;
8008 }
8009
8010 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8011 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8012 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8013 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8014 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8015
8016 static void
8017 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8018 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8019 {
8020 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8021 struct value *elt;
8022 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8023 {
8024 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (builtin_type_int32, index);
8025 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8026 }
8027 else
8028 {
8029 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8030 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value (elt));
8031 }
8032
8033 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8034 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8035 else
8036 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8037 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8038 EVAL_NORMAL));
8039
8040 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8041 }
8042
8043 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8044 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8045 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8046 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8047 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8048 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8049 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8050
8051 static struct value *
8052 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8053 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8054 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8055 {
8056 struct type *lhs_type;
8057 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8058 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8059 int num_specs;
8060 LONGEST *indices;
8061 int max_indices, num_indices;
8062 int is_array_aggregate;
8063 int i;
8064 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8065
8066 *pos += 3;
8067 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8068 {
8069 int i;
8070 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8071 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8072 return container;
8073 }
8074
8075 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8076 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8077 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8078 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8079 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8080 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8081
8082 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8083 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8084 {
8085 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8086 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8087 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8088 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8089 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8090 }
8091 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8092 {
8093 low_index = 0;
8094 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8095 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8096 }
8097 else
8098 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8099
8100 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8101 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8102 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8103 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8104 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8105 num_indices = 4;
8106
8107 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8108 {
8109 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8110 {
8111 case OP_CHOICES:
8112 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8113 &num_indices, max_indices,
8114 low_index, high_index);
8115 break;
8116 case OP_POSITIONAL:
8117 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8118 &num_indices, max_indices,
8119 low_index, high_index);
8120 break;
8121 case OP_OTHERS:
8122 if (i != n-1)
8123 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8124 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8125 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8126 break;
8127 default:
8128 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8129 }
8130 }
8131
8132 return container;
8133 }
8134
8135 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8136 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8137 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8138 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8139 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8140 assign_aggregate. */
8141 static void
8142 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8143 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8144 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8145 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8146 {
8147 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8148
8149 if (ind - 1 == high)
8150 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8151 if (ind <= high)
8152 {
8153 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8154 *pos += 3;
8155 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8156 }
8157 else
8158 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8159 }
8160
8161 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8162 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8163 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8164 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8165 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8166 static void
8167 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8168 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8169 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8170 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8171 {
8172 int j;
8173 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8174 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8175 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8176
8177 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8178
8179 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8180 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8181 expr_pc = *pos;
8182 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8183
8184 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8185 {
8186 LONGEST lower, upper;
8187 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8188 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8189 {
8190 choice_pos += 1;
8191 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8192 EVAL_NORMAL));
8193 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8194 EVAL_NORMAL));
8195 }
8196 else if (is_array)
8197 {
8198 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8199 EVAL_NORMAL));
8200 upper = lower;
8201 }
8202 else
8203 {
8204 int ind;
8205 char *name;
8206 switch (op)
8207 {
8208 case OP_NAME:
8209 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8210 break;
8211 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8212 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8213 break;
8214 default:
8215 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8216 }
8217 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8218 ind = 0;
8219 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8220 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8221 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8222 lower = upper = ind;
8223 }
8224
8225 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8226 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8227
8228 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
8229 max_indices);
8230 while (lower <= upper)
8231 {
8232 int pos1;
8233 pos1 = expr_pc;
8234 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
8235 lower += 1;
8236 }
8237 }
8238 }
8239
8240 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
8241 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
8242 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
8243 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
8244 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate*/
8245 static void
8246 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
8247 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8248 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
8249 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8250 {
8251 int i;
8252 int expr_pc = *pos+1;
8253
8254 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
8255 {
8256 LONGEST ind;
8257 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
8258 {
8259 int pos;
8260 pos = expr_pc;
8261 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &pos);
8262 }
8263 }
8264 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8265 }
8266
8267 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
8268 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
8269 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
8270 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
8271 static void
8272 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
8273 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
8274 {
8275 int i, j;
8276 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
8277 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
8278 {
8279 int kh;
8280 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
8281 if (high < indices[kh])
8282 break;
8283 if (low < indices[i])
8284 indices[i] = low;
8285 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
8286 if (high > indices[i + 1])
8287 indices[i + 1] = high;
8288 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
8289 *size -= kh - i - 2;
8290 return;
8291 }
8292 else if (high < indices[i])
8293 break;
8294 }
8295
8296 if (*size == max_size)
8297 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
8298 *size += 2;
8299 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
8300 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
8301 indices[i] = low;
8302 indices[i + 1] = high;
8303 }
8304
8305 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
8306 is different. */
8307
8308 static struct value *
8309 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
8310 {
8311 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
8312 return arg2;
8313
8314 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
8315 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
8316
8317 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8318 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8319
8320 return value_cast (type, arg2);
8321 }
8322
8323 static struct value *
8324 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
8325 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8326 {
8327 enum exp_opcode op;
8328 int tem, tem2, tem3;
8329 int pc;
8330 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
8331 struct type *type;
8332 int nargs, oplen;
8333 struct value **argvec;
8334
8335 pc = *pos;
8336 *pos += 1;
8337 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
8338
8339 switch (op)
8340 {
8341 default:
8342 *pos -= 1;
8343 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8344 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8345
8346 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
8347 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
8348 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
8349 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
8350 types in Ada have different representations.
8351
8352 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
8353 ourselves. */
8354 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
8355 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
8356
8357 return arg1;
8358
8359 case OP_STRING:
8360 {
8361 struct value *result;
8362 *pos -= 1;
8363 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8364 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
8365 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
8366 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
8367 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
8368 return result;
8369 }
8370
8371 case UNOP_CAST:
8372 (*pos) += 2;
8373 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8374 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8375 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8376 goto nosideret;
8377 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
8378 return arg1;
8379
8380 case UNOP_QUAL:
8381 (*pos) += 2;
8382 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8383 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8384
8385 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
8386 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8387 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8388 {
8389 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
8390 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8391 return arg1;
8392 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
8393 }
8394 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
8395 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
8396 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
8397 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
8398 type = value_type (arg1);
8399 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
8400 type = NULL;
8401 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8402 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8403 return arg1;
8404 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8405 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8406 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8407 error
8408 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
8409 else
8410 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8411 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
8412
8413 case BINOP_ADD:
8414 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8415 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8416 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8417 goto nosideret;
8418 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8419 return (value_from_longest
8420 (value_type (arg1),
8421 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
8422 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8423 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8424 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8425 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
8426 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
8427 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8428 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8429 type = value_type (arg1);
8430 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8431 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8432 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8433 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
8434
8435 case BINOP_SUB:
8436 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8437 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8438 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8439 goto nosideret;
8440 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8441 return (value_from_longest
8442 (value_type (arg1),
8443 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
8444 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8445 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8446 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8447 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction must have the same type"));
8448 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
8449 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8450 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8451 type = value_type (arg1);
8452 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8453 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8454 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8455 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
8456
8457 case BINOP_MUL:
8458 case BINOP_DIV:
8459 case BINOP_REM:
8460 case BINOP_MOD:
8461 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8462 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8463 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8464 goto nosideret;
8465 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8466 {
8467 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8468 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
8469 }
8470 else
8471 {
8472 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
8473 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8474 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
8475 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8476 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8477 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8478 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8479 }
8480
8481 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8482 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8483 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8484 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
8485 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8486 goto nosideret;
8487 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8488 tem = 0;
8489 else
8490 {
8491 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8492 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8493 }
8494 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
8495 tem = !tem;
8496 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8497 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
8498
8499 case UNOP_NEG:
8500 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8501 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8502 goto nosideret;
8503 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8504 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
8505 else
8506 {
8507 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
8508 return value_neg (arg1);
8509 }
8510
8511 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8512 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8513 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8514 {
8515 struct value *val;
8516
8517 *pos -= 1;
8518 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8519 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8520 return value_cast (type, val);
8521 }
8522
8523 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8524 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8525 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8526 {
8527 struct value *val;
8528
8529 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8530 *pos = pc;
8531 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8532
8533 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
8534 }
8535
8536 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8537 *pos -= 1;
8538
8539 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8540 {
8541 *pos += 4;
8542 goto nosideret;
8543 }
8544 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8545 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
8546 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
8547 invalid. */
8548 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8549 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8550 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8551 {
8552 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8553 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0))
8554 {
8555 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
8556 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
8557 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
8558 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
8559 type from its tag.
8560
8561 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
8562 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
8563 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
8564 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
8565 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
8566 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
8567 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
8568 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
8569 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
8570 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
8571 type in the type description. */
8572 struct type *actual_type;
8573
8574 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8575 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
8576 if (actual_type == NULL)
8577 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
8578 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
8579 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
8580 This can happen if the debugging information is
8581 incomplete, for instance. */
8582 actual_type = type;
8583
8584 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
8585 }
8586
8587 *pos += 4;
8588 return value_zero
8589 (to_static_fixed_type
8590 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
8591 not_lval);
8592 }
8593 else
8594 {
8595 arg1 =
8596 unwrap_value (evaluate_subexp_standard
8597 (expect_type, exp, pos, noside));
8598 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
8599 }
8600
8601 case OP_FUNCALL:
8602 (*pos) += 2;
8603
8604 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
8605 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
8606 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8607 argvec =
8608 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
8609
8610 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
8611 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8612 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8613 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
8614 else
8615 {
8616 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
8617 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8618 argvec[tem] = 0;
8619
8620 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8621 goto nosideret;
8622 }
8623
8624 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
8625 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
8626 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8627 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8628 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
8629 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
8630
8631 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
8632 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8633 {
8634 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
8635 {
8636 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8637 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8638 break;
8639 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8640 break;
8641 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8642 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8643 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
8644 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8645 break;
8646 default:
8647 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
8648 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
8649 break;
8650 }
8651 }
8652
8653 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8654 {
8655 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8656 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8657 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8658 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
8659 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8660 {
8661 int arity;
8662
8663 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
8664 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8665 if (type == NULL)
8666 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
8667 if (arity != nargs)
8668 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
8669 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8670 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8671 return
8672 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
8673 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
8674 }
8675 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8676 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8677 {
8678 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8679 if (type == NULL)
8680 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
8681 else
8682 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8683 }
8684 return
8685 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
8686 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
8687 nargs, argvec + 1));
8688 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
8689 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
8690 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8691 {
8692 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8693 if (type == NULL)
8694 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
8695 else
8696 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8697 }
8698 return
8699 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
8700 nargs, argvec + 1));
8701
8702 default:
8703 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
8704 "array or function"));
8705 }
8706
8707 case TERNOP_SLICE:
8708 {
8709 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8710 struct value *low_bound_val =
8711 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8712 struct value *high_bound_val =
8713 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8714 LONGEST low_bound;
8715 LONGEST high_bound;
8716 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
8717 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
8718 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
8719 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
8720
8721 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8722 goto nosideret;
8723
8724 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
8725 the aligners. */
8726 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8727 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
8728 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
8729 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
8730
8731 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
8732 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
8733
8734 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
8735 convert to a pointer. */
8736 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8737 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8738 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
8739 array = value_addr (array);
8740
8741 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8742 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
8743 (value_type (array))))
8744 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
8745
8746 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
8747
8748 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
8749 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
8750 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8751 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
8752 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
8753 array = value_ind (array);
8754
8755 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
8756 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
8757 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
8758 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
8759 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
8760 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
8761
8762 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8763 {
8764 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8765 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
8766 low_bound);
8767 else
8768 {
8769 struct type *arr_type0 =
8770 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
8771 NULL, 1);
8772 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
8773 longest_to_int (low_bound),
8774 longest_to_int (high_bound));
8775 }
8776 }
8777 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8778 return array;
8779 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
8780 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
8781 else
8782 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
8783 longest_to_int (high_bound));
8784 }
8785
8786 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
8787 (*pos) += 2;
8788 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8789 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
8790
8791 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8792 goto nosideret;
8793
8794 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8795 {
8796 default:
8797 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
8798 "always returns true"));
8799 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8800 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
8801
8802 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
8803 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
8804 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
8805 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8806 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
8807 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8808 return
8809 value_from_longest (type,
8810 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8811 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8812 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8813 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8814 }
8815
8816 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
8817 (*pos) += 2;
8818 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8819 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8820
8821 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8822 goto nosideret;
8823
8824 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8825 {
8826 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8827 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
8828 }
8829
8830 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8831
8832 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (value_type (arg2)))
8833 error (_("invalid dimension number to 'range"));
8834
8835 arg3 = ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1);
8836 arg2 = ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0);
8837
8838 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8839 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
8840 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8841 return
8842 value_from_longest (type,
8843 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8844 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8845 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8846 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8847
8848 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
8849 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8850 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8851 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8852
8853 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8854 goto nosideret;
8855
8856 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8857 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
8858 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8859 return
8860 value_from_longest (type,
8861 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8862 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8863 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8864 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8865
8866 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8867 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8868 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8869 {
8870 struct type *type_arg;
8871 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
8872 {
8873 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8874 arg1 = NULL;
8875 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
8876 }
8877 else
8878 {
8879 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8880 type_arg = NULL;
8881 }
8882
8883 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
8884 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
8885 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
8886 *pos += 4;
8887
8888 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8889 goto nosideret;
8890
8891 if (type_arg == NULL)
8892 {
8893 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8894
8895 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
8896 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8897
8898 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (value_type (arg1)))
8899 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"),
8900 ada_attribute_name (op));
8901
8902 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8903 {
8904 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem);
8905 if (type == NULL)
8906 error
8907 (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
8908 return allocate_value (type);
8909 }
8910
8911 switch (op)
8912 {
8913 default: /* Should never happen. */
8914 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
8915 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8916 return ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0);
8917 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8918 return ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1);
8919 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8920 return ada_array_length (arg1, tem);
8921 }
8922 }
8923 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
8924 {
8925 struct type *range_type;
8926 char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
8927 range_type = NULL;
8928 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8929 range_type =
8930 to_fixed_range_type (name, NULL, TYPE_OBJFILE (type_arg));
8931 if (range_type == NULL)
8932 range_type = type_arg;
8933 switch (op)
8934 {
8935 default:
8936 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
8937 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8938 return value_from_longest
8939 (range_type, discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
8940 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8941 return value_from_longest
8942 (range_type, discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
8943 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8944 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
8945 }
8946 }
8947 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
8948 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
8949 else
8950 {
8951 LONGEST low, high;
8952
8953 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type_arg))
8954 type_arg = decode_packed_array_type (type_arg);
8955
8956 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (type_arg))
8957 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"),
8958 ada_attribute_name (op));
8959
8960 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem);
8961 if (type == NULL)
8962 error
8963 (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
8964 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8965 return allocate_value (type);
8966
8967 switch (op)
8968 {
8969 default:
8970 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
8971 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8972 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0, &type);
8973 return value_from_longest (type, low);
8974 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8975 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1, &type);
8976 return value_from_longest (type, high);
8977 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8978 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0, &type);
8979 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1, NULL);
8980 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
8981 }
8982 }
8983 }
8984
8985 case OP_ATR_TAG:
8986 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8987 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8988 goto nosideret;
8989
8990 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8991 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
8992
8993 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
8994
8995 case OP_ATR_MIN:
8996 case OP_ATR_MAX:
8997 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8998 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8999 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9000 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9001 goto nosideret;
9002 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9003 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9004 else
9005 {
9006 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9007 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
9008 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
9009 }
9010
9011 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
9012 {
9013 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9014 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9015
9016 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9017 goto nosideret;
9018
9019 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
9020 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
9021
9022 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
9023 ada_modulus (type_arg));
9024 }
9025
9026
9027 case OP_ATR_POS:
9028 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9029 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9030 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9031 goto nosideret;
9032 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9033 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9034 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9035 else
9036 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
9037
9038 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
9039 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9040 type = value_type (arg1);
9041
9042 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
9043 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
9044 not the size of the pointer. */
9045 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9046 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9047
9048 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9049 goto nosideret;
9050 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9051 return value_zero (builtin_type_int32, not_lval);
9052 else
9053 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_int32,
9054 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
9055
9056 case OP_ATR_VAL:
9057 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9058 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9059 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
9060 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9061 goto nosideret;
9062 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9063 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9064 else
9065 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
9066
9067 case BINOP_EXP:
9068 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9069 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9070 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9071 goto nosideret;
9072 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9073 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9074 else
9075 {
9076 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
9077 only promote the first argument. */
9078 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
9079 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9080 else
9081 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9082
9083 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9084 }
9085
9086 case UNOP_PLUS:
9087 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9088 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9089 goto nosideret;
9090 else
9091 return arg1;
9092
9093 case UNOP_ABS:
9094 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9095 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9096 goto nosideret;
9097 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9098 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
9099 return value_neg (arg1);
9100 else
9101 return arg1;
9102
9103 case UNOP_IND:
9104 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9105 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9106 goto nosideret;
9107 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9108 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9109 {
9110 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9111 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9112 {
9113 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
9114 if (arrType == NULL)
9115 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
9116 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
9117 }
9118 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9119 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9120 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
9121 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9122 {
9123 type = to_static_fixed_type
9124 (ada_aligned_type
9125 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
9126 check_size (type);
9127 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
9128 }
9129 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9130 {
9131 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
9132 if (expect_type == NULL)
9133 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9134 lval_memory);
9135 else
9136 {
9137 expect_type =
9138 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
9139 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
9140 }
9141 }
9142 else
9143 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
9144 }
9145 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
9146 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9147
9148 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9149 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
9150 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
9151 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
9152 {
9153 if (expect_type != NULL)
9154 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
9155 arg1));
9156 else
9157 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9158 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
9159 }
9160
9161 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9162 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9163 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9164 else
9165 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
9166
9167 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
9168 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9169 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
9170 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9171 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9172 goto nosideret;
9173 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9174 {
9175 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
9176 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
9177 {
9178 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
9179 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
9180 1, 1, NULL);
9181 if (type == NULL)
9182 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
9183 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
9184 "type" void, which will match any formal
9185 (see ada_type_match). */
9186 return value_zero (builtin_type_void, lval_memory);
9187 }
9188 else
9189 type =
9190 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
9191 0, NULL);
9192
9193 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9194 }
9195 else
9196 return
9197 ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value
9198 (ada_value_struct_elt
9199 (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0)));
9200 case OP_TYPE:
9201 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
9202 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
9203 (*pos) += 2;
9204 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9205 goto nosideret;
9206 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9207 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9208 else
9209 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
9210
9211 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9212 case OP_CHOICES:
9213 case OP_OTHERS:
9214 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
9215 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9216 case OP_NAME:
9217 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
9218 switch (op)
9219 {
9220 case OP_NAME:
9221 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
9222 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
9223 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9224 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
9225 default:
9226 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
9227 }
9228
9229 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
9230 *pos += oplen - 1;
9231 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
9232 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9233 goto nosideret;
9234 }
9235
9236 nosideret:
9237 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_int8, (LONGEST) 1);
9238 }
9239 \f
9240
9241 /* Fixed point */
9242
9243 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
9244 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
9245 Otherwise, return NULL. */
9246
9247 static const char *
9248 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
9249 {
9250 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9251 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
9252
9253 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
9254 {
9255 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
9256 if (tail == NULL)
9257 return NULL;
9258 else
9259 return tail + 5;
9260 }
9261 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
9262 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9263 else
9264 return NULL;
9265 }
9266
9267 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
9268
9269 int
9270 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
9271 {
9272 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
9273 }
9274
9275 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
9276
9277 int
9278 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
9279 {
9280 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
9281 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
9282 }
9283
9284 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
9285 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
9286 delta cannot be determined. */
9287
9288 DOUBLEST
9289 ada_delta (struct type *type)
9290 {
9291 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9292 DOUBLEST num, den;
9293
9294 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
9295 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9296 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9297 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9298 &num, &den) < 2)
9299 return -1.0;
9300 else
9301 return num / den;
9302 }
9303
9304 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
9305 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
9306
9307 static DOUBLEST
9308 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
9309 {
9310 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9311 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
9312 int n;
9313
9314 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
9315 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9316 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9317 n = sscanf (encoding,
9318 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
9319 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9320 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
9321
9322 if (n < 2)
9323 return 1.0;
9324 else if (n == 4)
9325 return num1 / den1;
9326 else
9327 return num0 / den0;
9328 }
9329
9330
9331 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
9332 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
9333
9334 DOUBLEST
9335 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
9336 {
9337 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
9338 }
9339
9340 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
9341 corresponding to the value X. */
9342
9343 LONGEST
9344 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
9345 {
9346 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
9347 }
9348
9349
9350 /* VAX floating formats */
9351
9352 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents one of the special VAX floating-point
9353 types. */
9354
9355 int
9356 ada_is_vax_floating_type (struct type *type)
9357 {
9358 int name_len =
9359 (ada_type_name (type) == NULL) ? 0 : strlen (ada_type_name (type));
9360 return
9361 name_len > 6
9362 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9363 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9364 && strncmp (ada_type_name (type) + name_len - 6, "___XF", 5) == 0;
9365 }
9366
9367 /* The type of special VAX floating-point type this is, assuming
9368 ada_is_vax_floating_point. */
9369
9370 int
9371 ada_vax_float_type_suffix (struct type *type)
9372 {
9373 return ada_type_name (type)[strlen (ada_type_name (type)) - 1];
9374 }
9375
9376 /* A value representing the special debugging function that outputs
9377 VAX floating-point values of the type represented by TYPE. Assumes
9378 ada_is_vax_floating_type (TYPE). */
9379
9380 struct value *
9381 ada_vax_float_print_function (struct type *type)
9382 {
9383 switch (ada_vax_float_type_suffix (type))
9384 {
9385 case 'F':
9386 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_F", 0);
9387 case 'D':
9388 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_D", 0);
9389 case 'G':
9390 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_G", 0);
9391 default:
9392 error (_("invalid VAX floating-point type"));
9393 }
9394 }
9395 \f
9396
9397 /* Range types */
9398
9399 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
9400 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
9401 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
9402 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
9403 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
9404
9405 static int
9406 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
9407 int *pnew_k)
9408 {
9409 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
9410 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
9411 char *bound;
9412 char *pend;
9413 struct value *bound_val;
9414
9415 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
9416 return 0;
9417
9418 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
9419 if (pend == NULL)
9420 {
9421 bound = str + k;
9422 k += strlen (bound);
9423 }
9424 else
9425 {
9426 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
9427 bound = bound_buffer;
9428 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
9429 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
9430 k = pend - str;
9431 }
9432
9433 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
9434 if (bound_val == NULL)
9435 return 0;
9436
9437 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
9438 if (pnew_k != NULL)
9439 *pnew_k = k;
9440 return 1;
9441 }
9442
9443 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9444 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
9445 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
9446
9447 static struct value *
9448 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
9449 {
9450 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
9451 int nsyms;
9452
9453 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
9454 &syms);
9455
9456 if (nsyms != 1)
9457 {
9458 if (err_msg == NULL)
9459 return 0;
9460 else
9461 error (("%s"), err_msg);
9462 }
9463
9464 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
9465 }
9466
9467 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9468 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
9469 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
9470
9471 LONGEST
9472 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
9473 {
9474 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
9475
9476 if (var_val == 0)
9477 {
9478 if (flag != NULL)
9479 *flag = 0;
9480 return 0;
9481 }
9482 else
9483 {
9484 if (flag != NULL)
9485 *flag = 1;
9486 return value_as_long (var_val);
9487 }
9488 }
9489
9490
9491 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
9492 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
9493 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
9494 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. If a new type
9495 must be created, allocate in OBJFILE's space. The bounds
9496 information, in general, is encoded in NAME, the base type given in
9497 the named range type. */
9498
9499 static struct type *
9500 to_fixed_range_type (char *name, struct value *dval, struct objfile *objfile)
9501 {
9502 struct type *raw_type = ada_find_any_type (name);
9503 struct type *base_type;
9504 char *subtype_info;
9505
9506 if (raw_type == NULL)
9507 base_type = builtin_type_int32;
9508 else if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9509 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
9510 else
9511 base_type = raw_type;
9512
9513 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
9514 if (subtype_info == NULL)
9515 {
9516 LONGEST L = discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
9517 LONGEST U = discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
9518 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
9519 return raw_type;
9520 else
9521 return create_range_type (alloc_type (objfile), raw_type,
9522 discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
9523 discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
9524 }
9525 else
9526 {
9527 static char *name_buf = NULL;
9528 static size_t name_len = 0;
9529 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
9530 LONGEST L, U;
9531 struct type *type;
9532 char *bounds_str;
9533 int n;
9534
9535 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
9536 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
9537 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
9538
9539 subtype_info += 5;
9540 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
9541 n = 1;
9542
9543 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
9544 {
9545 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
9546 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
9547 return raw_type;
9548 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
9549 n += 2;
9550 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
9551 n += 1;
9552 subtype_info += 1;
9553 }
9554 else
9555 {
9556 int ok;
9557 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
9558 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9559 if (!ok)
9560 {
9561 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
9562 L = 1;
9563 }
9564 }
9565
9566 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
9567 {
9568 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
9569 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
9570 return raw_type;
9571 }
9572 else
9573 {
9574 int ok;
9575 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
9576 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9577 if (!ok)
9578 {
9579 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
9580 U = L;
9581 }
9582 }
9583
9584 if (objfile == NULL)
9585 objfile = TYPE_OBJFILE (base_type);
9586 type = create_range_type (alloc_type (objfile), base_type, L, U);
9587 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
9588 return type;
9589 }
9590 }
9591
9592 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
9593
9594 int
9595 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
9596 {
9597 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
9598 }
9599 \f
9600
9601 /* Modular types */
9602
9603 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
9604
9605 int
9606 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
9607 {
9608 struct type *subranged_type = base_type (type);
9609
9610 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
9611 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9612 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
9613 }
9614
9615 /* Try to determine the lower and upper bounds of the given modular type
9616 using the type name only. Return non-zero and set L and U as the lower
9617 and upper bounds (respectively) if successful. */
9618
9619 int
9620 ada_modulus_from_name (struct type *type, ULONGEST *modulus)
9621 {
9622 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9623 char *suffix;
9624 int k;
9625 LONGEST U;
9626
9627 if (name == NULL)
9628 return 0;
9629
9630 /* Discrete type bounds are encoded using an __XD suffix. In our case,
9631 we are looking for static bounds, which means an __XDLU suffix.
9632 Moreover, we know that the lower bound of modular types is always
9633 zero, so the actual suffix should start with "__XDLU_0__", and
9634 then be followed by the upper bound value. */
9635 suffix = strstr (name, "__XDLU_0__");
9636 if (suffix == NULL)
9637 return 0;
9638 k = 10;
9639 if (!ada_scan_number (suffix, k, &U, NULL))
9640 return 0;
9641
9642 *modulus = (ULONGEST) U + 1;
9643 return 1;
9644 }
9645
9646 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
9647
9648 ULONGEST
9649 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
9650 {
9651 ULONGEST modulus;
9652
9653 /* Normally, the modulus of a modular type is equal to the value of
9654 its upper bound + 1. However, the upper bound is currently stored
9655 as an int, which is not always big enough to hold the actual bound
9656 value. To workaround this, try to take advantage of the encoding
9657 that GNAT uses with with discrete types. To avoid some unnecessary
9658 parsing, we do this only when the size of TYPE is greater than
9659 the size of the field holding the bound. */
9660 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > sizeof (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type))
9661 && ada_modulus_from_name (type, &modulus))
9662 return modulus;
9663
9664 return (ULONGEST) (unsigned int) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
9665 }
9666 \f
9667
9668 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
9669 ---------------------------------
9670
9671 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
9672 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
9673 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
9674 . catchpoints on failed assertions
9675
9676 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
9677 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
9678 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
9679 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
9680 to zero-in on certain situations.
9681
9682 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
9683 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
9684 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
9685 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
9686 of breakpoint_ops.
9687
9688 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
9689 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
9690 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
9691 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
9692 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged.
9693
9694 At this time, we do not support the use of conditions on Ada exception
9695 catchpoints. The COND and COND_STRING fields are therefore set
9696 to NULL (most of the time, see below).
9697
9698 Conditions where EXP_STRING, COND, and COND_STRING are used:
9699
9700 When a user specifies the name of a specific exception in the case
9701 of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, we store the name of that exception
9702 in the EXP_STRING. We then translate this request into an actual
9703 condition stored in COND_STRING, and then parse it into an expression
9704 stored in COND. */
9705
9706 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
9707 Ada exceptions. */
9708
9709 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
9710 {
9711 ex_catch_exception,
9712 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
9713 ex_catch_assert
9714 };
9715
9716 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
9717
9718 static char *standard_exc[] = {
9719 "constraint_error",
9720 "program_error",
9721 "storage_error",
9722 "tasking_error"
9723 };
9724
9725 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
9726
9727 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
9728 for a given executable. */
9729
9730 struct exception_support_info
9731 {
9732 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9733 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
9734 const char *catch_exception_sym;
9735
9736 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9737 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
9738 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
9739
9740 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9741 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
9742 const char *catch_assert_sym;
9743
9744 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
9745 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
9746 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
9747 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
9748 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
9749 };
9750
9751 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
9752 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
9753
9754 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
9755 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
9756 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
9757
9758 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
9759 {
9760 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
9761 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
9762 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
9763 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
9764 };
9765
9766 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
9767 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
9768 of the Ada runtime. */
9769
9770 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
9771 {
9772 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
9773 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
9774 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
9775 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
9776 };
9777
9778 /* For each executable, we sniff which exception info structure to use
9779 and cache it in the following global variable. */
9780
9781 static const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = NULL;
9782
9783 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
9784 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
9785
9786 This function will always set exception_info, or raise an error. */
9787
9788 static void
9789 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
9790 {
9791 struct symbol *sym;
9792
9793 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
9794 if (exception_info != NULL)
9795 return;
9796
9797 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
9798 sym = standard_lookup (default_exception_support_info.catch_exception_sym,
9799 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
9800 if (sym != NULL)
9801 {
9802 exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
9803 return;
9804 }
9805
9806 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
9807 sym = standard_lookup (exception_support_info_fallback.catch_exception_sym,
9808 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
9809 if (sym != NULL)
9810 {
9811 exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
9812 return;
9813 }
9814
9815 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
9816 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
9817 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
9818 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
9819 applicable. */
9820
9821 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown, NULL) != language_ada)
9822 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
9823
9824 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
9825 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
9826 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
9827 in a shared library. */
9828
9829 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
9830 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
9831
9832 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
9833 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
9834 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
9835 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
9836 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
9837 supporting this feature. */
9838
9839 error (_("Cannot insert catchpoints in this configuration."));
9840 }
9841
9842 /* An observer of "executable_changed" events.
9843 Its role is to clear certain cached values that need to be recomputed
9844 each time a new executable is loaded by GDB. */
9845
9846 static void
9847 ada_executable_changed_observer (void)
9848 {
9849 /* If the executable changed, then it is possible that the Ada runtime
9850 is different. So we need to invalidate the exception support info
9851 cache. */
9852 exception_info = NULL;
9853 }
9854
9855 /* Return the name of the function at PC, NULL if could not find it.
9856 This function only checks the debugging information, not the symbol
9857 table. */
9858
9859 static char *
9860 function_name_from_pc (CORE_ADDR pc)
9861 {
9862 char *func_name;
9863
9864 if (!find_pc_partial_function (pc, &func_name, NULL, NULL))
9865 return NULL;
9866
9867 return func_name;
9868 }
9869
9870 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
9871 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
9872 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
9873 to most users. */
9874
9875 static int
9876 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
9877 {
9878 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9879 char *func_name;
9880 int i;
9881
9882 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
9883 This cannot be any user code. */
9884
9885 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
9886 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
9887 return 1;
9888
9889 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
9890 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
9891 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
9892 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
9893 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
9894
9895 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
9896 return 1;
9897
9898 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
9899 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
9900 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
9901 too. */
9902
9903 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
9904 {
9905 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
9906 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
9907 return 1;
9908 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
9909 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
9910 return 1;
9911 }
9912
9913 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
9914
9915 func_name = function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (frame));
9916 if (func_name == NULL)
9917 return 1;
9918
9919 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
9920 {
9921 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
9922 if (re_exec (func_name))
9923 return 1;
9924 }
9925
9926 return 0;
9927 }
9928
9929 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
9930 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
9931
9932 void
9933 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
9934 {
9935 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
9936 {
9937 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
9938 {
9939 select_frame (fi);
9940 break;
9941 }
9942 }
9943
9944 }
9945
9946 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
9947 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
9948 of the exception is stored.
9949
9950 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
9951
9952 static CORE_ADDR
9953 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
9954 {
9955 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
9956 }
9957
9958 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
9959 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
9960 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
9961 several frames up in the callstack. */
9962
9963 static CORE_ADDR
9964 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
9965 {
9966 int frame_level;
9967 struct frame_info *fi;
9968
9969 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
9970 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
9971 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
9972 without checking the name of their associated function. */
9973 fi = get_current_frame ();
9974 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
9975 if (fi != NULL)
9976 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
9977
9978 while (fi != NULL)
9979 {
9980 const char *func_name =
9981 function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (fi));
9982 if (func_name != NULL
9983 && strcmp (func_name, exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
9984 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
9985 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
9986 }
9987
9988 if (fi == NULL)
9989 return 0;
9990
9991 select_frame (fi);
9992 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
9993 }
9994
9995 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
9996 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
9997 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
9998
9999 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
10000
10001 static CORE_ADDR
10002 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10003 struct breakpoint *b)
10004 {
10005 switch (ex)
10006 {
10007 case ex_catch_exception:
10008 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
10009 break;
10010
10011 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10012 return exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
10013 break;
10014
10015 case ex_catch_assert:
10016 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
10017 break;
10018
10019 default:
10020 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10021 break;
10022 }
10023
10024 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
10025 }
10026
10027 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
10028 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
10029 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
10030 and zero is returned. */
10031
10032 static CORE_ADDR
10033 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10034 struct breakpoint *b)
10035 {
10036 struct gdb_exception e;
10037 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
10038
10039 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10040 {
10041 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
10042 }
10043
10044 if (e.reason < 0)
10045 {
10046 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
10047 return 0;
10048 }
10049
10050 return result;
10051 }
10052
10053 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10054 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10055
10056 static enum print_stop_action
10057 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
10058 {
10059 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
10060 char exception_name[256];
10061
10062 if (addr != 0)
10063 {
10064 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
10065 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
10066 }
10067
10068 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
10069
10070 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
10071 switch (ex)
10072 {
10073 case ex_catch_exception:
10074 if (addr != 0)
10075 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, %s at "),
10076 b->number, exception_name);
10077 else
10078 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, exception at "), b->number);
10079 break;
10080 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10081 if (addr != 0)
10082 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled %s at "),
10083 b->number, exception_name);
10084 else
10085 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled exception at "),
10086 b->number);
10087 break;
10088 case ex_catch_assert:
10089 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, failed assertion at "),
10090 b->number);
10091 break;
10092 }
10093
10094 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10095 }
10096
10097 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10098 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10099
10100 static void
10101 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10102 struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10103 {
10104 struct value_print_options opts;
10105
10106 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10107 if (opts.addressprint)
10108 {
10109 annotate_field (4);
10110 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->address);
10111 }
10112
10113 annotate_field (5);
10114 *last_addr = b->loc->address;
10115 switch (ex)
10116 {
10117 case ex_catch_exception:
10118 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10119 {
10120 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), b->exp_string);
10121
10122 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
10123 xfree (msg);
10124 }
10125 else
10126 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
10127
10128 break;
10129
10130 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10131 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
10132 break;
10133
10134 case ex_catch_assert:
10135 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
10136 break;
10137
10138 default:
10139 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10140 break;
10141 }
10142 }
10143
10144 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10145 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10146
10147 static void
10148 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10149 struct breakpoint *b)
10150 {
10151 switch (ex)
10152 {
10153 case ex_catch_exception:
10154 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10155 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: `%s' Ada exception"),
10156 b->number, b->exp_string);
10157 else
10158 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: all Ada exceptions"), b->number);
10159
10160 break;
10161
10162 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10163 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: unhandled Ada exceptions"),
10164 b->number);
10165 break;
10166
10167 case ex_catch_assert:
10168 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: failed Ada assertions"), b->number);
10169 break;
10170
10171 default:
10172 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10173 break;
10174 }
10175 }
10176
10177 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
10178
10179 static enum print_stop_action
10180 print_it_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10181 {
10182 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10183 }
10184
10185 static void
10186 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10187 {
10188 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_addr);
10189 }
10190
10191 static void
10192 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10193 {
10194 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10195 }
10196
10197 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops =
10198 {
10199 NULL, /* insert */
10200 NULL, /* remove */
10201 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10202 print_it_catch_exception,
10203 print_one_catch_exception,
10204 print_mention_catch_exception
10205 };
10206
10207 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
10208
10209 static enum print_stop_action
10210 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10211 {
10212 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10213 }
10214
10215 static void
10216 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10217 {
10218 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_addr);
10219 }
10220
10221 static void
10222 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10223 {
10224 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10225 }
10226
10227 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops = {
10228 NULL, /* insert */
10229 NULL, /* remove */
10230 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10231 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled,
10232 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled,
10233 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled
10234 };
10235
10236 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
10237
10238 static enum print_stop_action
10239 print_it_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10240 {
10241 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10242 }
10243
10244 static void
10245 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10246 {
10247 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_addr);
10248 }
10249
10250 static void
10251 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10252 {
10253 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10254 }
10255
10256 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops = {
10257 NULL, /* insert */
10258 NULL, /* remove */
10259 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10260 print_it_catch_assert,
10261 print_one_catch_assert,
10262 print_mention_catch_assert
10263 };
10264
10265 /* Return non-zero if B is an Ada exception catchpoint. */
10266
10267 int
10268 ada_exception_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
10269 {
10270 return (b->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
10271 || b->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
10272 || b->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10273 }
10274
10275 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
10276 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
10277 token.
10278
10279 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
10280
10281 static char *
10282 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
10283 {
10284 char *args = *argsp;
10285 char *end;
10286 char *result;
10287
10288 /* Skip any leading white space. */
10289
10290 while (isspace (*args))
10291 args++;
10292
10293 if (args[0] == '\0')
10294 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
10295
10296 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
10297
10298 end = args;
10299 while (*end != '\0' && !isspace (*end))
10300 end++;
10301
10302 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
10303
10304 *argsp = end;
10305
10306 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
10307
10308 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
10309 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
10310 result[end - args] = '\0';
10311
10312 return result;
10313 }
10314
10315 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
10316 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
10317 Set EXP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
10318 specified by the user. */
10319
10320 static void
10321 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
10322 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
10323 char **exp_string)
10324 {
10325 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10326 char *exception_name;
10327
10328 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
10329 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
10330
10331 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
10332 is unexpected. */
10333
10334 while (isspace (*args))
10335 args++;
10336
10337 if (args[0] != '\0')
10338 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
10339
10340 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
10341
10342 if (exception_name == NULL)
10343 {
10344 /* Catch all exceptions. */
10345 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10346 *exp_string = NULL;
10347 }
10348 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
10349 {
10350 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
10351 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
10352 *exp_string = NULL;
10353 }
10354 else
10355 {
10356 /* Catch a specific exception. */
10357 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10358 *exp_string = exception_name;
10359 }
10360 }
10361
10362 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
10363 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
10364
10365 static const char *
10366 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10367 {
10368 gdb_assert (exception_info != NULL);
10369
10370 switch (ex)
10371 {
10372 case ex_catch_exception:
10373 return (exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
10374 break;
10375 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10376 return (exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
10377 break;
10378 case ex_catch_assert:
10379 return (exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
10380 break;
10381 default:
10382 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10383 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10384 }
10385 }
10386
10387 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
10388 of the EX kind. */
10389
10390 static struct breakpoint_ops *
10391 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10392 {
10393 switch (ex)
10394 {
10395 case ex_catch_exception:
10396 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
10397 break;
10398 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10399 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
10400 break;
10401 case ex_catch_assert:
10402 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10403 break;
10404 default:
10405 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10406 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10407 }
10408 }
10409
10410 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
10411 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
10412 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
10413 an exception catchpoint.
10414
10415 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
10416 deallocated later. */
10417
10418 static char *
10419 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *exp_string)
10420 {
10421 int i;
10422
10423 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
10424 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
10425 EXP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
10426 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
10427 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
10428 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
10429 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
10430 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
10431
10432 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
10433 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
10434 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
10435 standard.constraint_error".
10436
10437 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
10438 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
10439 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
10440 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
10441
10442 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
10443 {
10444 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], exp_string) == 0)
10445 {
10446 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
10447 exp_string);
10448 }
10449 }
10450 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", exp_string);
10451 }
10452
10453 /* Return the expression corresponding to COND_STRING evaluated at SAL. */
10454
10455 static struct expression *
10456 ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (char *cond_string,
10457 struct symtab_and_line sal)
10458 {
10459 return (parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0));
10460 }
10461
10462 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
10463 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
10464
10465 EX_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception
10466 that the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
10467
10468 The idea behind all the remaining parameters is that their names match
10469 the name of certain fields in the breakpoint structure that are used to
10470 handle exception catchpoints. This function returns the value to which
10471 these fields should be set, depending on the type of catchpoint we need
10472 to create.
10473
10474 If COND and COND_STRING are both non-NULL, any value they might
10475 hold will be free'ed, and then replaced by newly allocated ones.
10476 These parameters are left untouched otherwise. */
10477
10478 static struct symtab_and_line
10479 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *exp_string,
10480 char **addr_string, char **cond_string,
10481 struct expression **cond, struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10482 {
10483 const char *sym_name;
10484 struct symbol *sym;
10485 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10486
10487 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
10488 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
10489
10490 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
10491 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
10492
10493 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
10494 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10495
10496 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10497 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10498 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. If we don't find it, then
10499 the target most likely does not support Ada exceptions, or we cannot
10500 insert exception breakpoints yet, because the GNAT runtime hasn't been
10501 loaded yet. */
10502
10503 /* brobecker/2006-12-26: It is conceivable that the runtime was compiled
10504 in such a way that no debugging information is produced for the symbol
10505 we are looking for. In this case, we could search the minimal symbols
10506 as a fall-back mechanism. This would still be operating in degraded
10507 mode, however, as we would still be missing the debugging information
10508 that is needed in order to extract the name of the exception being
10509 raised (this name is printed in the catchpoint message, and is also
10510 used when trying to catch a specific exception). We do not handle
10511 this case for now. */
10512
10513 if (sym == NULL)
10514 error (_("Unable to break on '%s' in this configuration."), sym_name);
10515
10516 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10517 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10518 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10519 sym_name, SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10520
10521 sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
10522
10523 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
10524
10525 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
10526
10527 /* Set the COND and COND_STRING (if not NULL). */
10528
10529 if (cond_string != NULL && cond != NULL)
10530 {
10531 if (*cond_string != NULL)
10532 {
10533 xfree (*cond_string);
10534 *cond_string = NULL;
10535 }
10536 if (*cond != NULL)
10537 {
10538 xfree (*cond);
10539 *cond = NULL;
10540 }
10541 if (exp_string != NULL)
10542 {
10543 *cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (exp_string);
10544 *cond = ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (*cond_string, sal);
10545 }
10546 }
10547
10548 /* Set OPS. */
10549 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
10550
10551 return sal;
10552 }
10553
10554 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
10555
10556 Set TYPE to the appropriate exception catchpoint type.
10557 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
10558 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
10559
10560 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
10561 function arguments of this function. */
10562
10563 struct symtab_and_line
10564 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10565 char **exp_string, char **cond_string,
10566 struct expression **cond,
10567 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10568 {
10569 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
10570
10571 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, exp_string);
10572 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *exp_string, addr_string, cond_string,
10573 cond, ops);
10574 }
10575
10576 struct symtab_and_line
10577 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10578 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10579 {
10580 /* Check that no argument where provided at the end of the command. */
10581
10582 if (args != NULL)
10583 {
10584 while (isspace (*args))
10585 args++;
10586 if (*args != '\0')
10587 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10588 }
10589
10590 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, NULL, NULL,
10591 ops);
10592 }
10593
10594 /* Operators */
10595 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
10596 below. */
10597 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
10598
10599 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
10600 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
10601 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
10602 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
10603 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
10604 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
10605 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
10606 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
10607 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
10608 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
10609 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
10610 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
10611 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
10612 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
10613 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
10614 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10615 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
10616 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
10617 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10618 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
10619
10620 static void
10621 ada_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10622 {
10623 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
10624 {
10625 default:
10626 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
10627 break;
10628
10629 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10630 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10631 ADA_OPERATORS;
10632 #undef OP_DEFN
10633
10634 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10635 *oplenp = 3;
10636 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
10637 break;
10638
10639 case OP_CHOICES:
10640 *oplenp = 3;
10641 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
10642 break;
10643 }
10644 }
10645
10646 static char *
10647 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
10648 {
10649 switch (opcode)
10650 {
10651 default:
10652 return op_name_standard (opcode);
10653
10654 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
10655 ADA_OPERATORS;
10656 #undef OP_DEFN
10657
10658 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10659 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
10660 case OP_CHOICES:
10661 return "OP_CHOICES";
10662 case OP_NAME:
10663 return "OP_NAME";
10664 }
10665 }
10666
10667 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
10668 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
10669 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
10670
10671 static void
10672 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
10673 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10674 {
10675 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
10676 {
10677 default:
10678 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
10679 break;
10680
10681 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10682 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10683 ADA_OPERATORS;
10684 #undef OP_DEFN
10685
10686 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10687 *oplenp = 3;
10688 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10689 break;
10690
10691 case OP_CHOICES:
10692 *oplenp = 3;
10693 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
10694 break;
10695
10696 case OP_STRING:
10697 case OP_NAME:
10698 {
10699 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10700 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
10701 *argsp = 0;
10702 break;
10703 }
10704 }
10705 }
10706
10707 static int
10708 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
10709 {
10710 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
10711 int oplen, nargs;
10712 int pc = elt;
10713 int i;
10714
10715 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
10716
10717 switch (op)
10718 {
10719 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
10720 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10721 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10722 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10723 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
10724 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10725 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10726 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10727 case OP_ATR_POS:
10728 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10729 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10730 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10731 break;
10732
10733 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10734 case UNOP_QUAL:
10735 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
10736 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
10737 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
10738 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
10739 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
10740 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
10741 break;
10742 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10743 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
10744 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
10745 break;
10746 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10747 break;
10748
10749 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10750 case OP_OTHERS:
10751 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10752 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10753 case OP_CHOICES:
10754 break;
10755
10756 case OP_NAME:
10757 case OP_STRING:
10758 {
10759 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
10760 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
10761 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
10762 break;
10763 }
10764
10765 default:
10766 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
10767 }
10768
10769 elt += oplen;
10770 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
10771 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
10772
10773 return elt;
10774 }
10775
10776 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
10777
10778 static void
10779 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
10780 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
10781 {
10782 int oplen, nargs, i;
10783 int pc = *pos;
10784 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10785
10786 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
10787
10788 *pos += oplen;
10789 switch (op)
10790 {
10791 default:
10792 *pos -= oplen;
10793 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
10794 return;
10795
10796 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10797 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
10798 return;
10799
10800 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10801 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10802 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10803 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10804 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10805 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
10806 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
10807 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
10808 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10809 return;
10810
10811 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10812 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
10813 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
10814 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10815 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10816 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10817 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
10818 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
10819 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
10820 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
10821 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10822 return;
10823
10824 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10825 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10826 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10827 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
10828 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10829 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10830 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10831 case OP_ATR_POS:
10832 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10833 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10834 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10835 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10836 {
10837 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
10838 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
10839 *pos += 3;
10840 }
10841 else
10842 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10843 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
10844 if (nargs > 1)
10845 {
10846 int tem;
10847 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
10848 {
10849 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
10850 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
10851 }
10852 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10853 }
10854 return;
10855
10856 case UNOP_QUAL:
10857 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
10858 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
10859 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
10860 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10861 return;
10862
10863 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10864 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10865 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10866 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10867 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
10868 return;
10869
10870 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10871 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10872 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
10873 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10874 return;
10875
10876 case OP_OTHERS:
10877 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
10878 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10879 return;
10880
10881 case OP_CHOICES:
10882 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
10883 {
10884 if (i > 0)
10885 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
10886 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10887 }
10888 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
10889 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10890 return;
10891
10892 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10893 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10894 return;
10895
10896 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10897 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
10898 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
10899 {
10900 if (i > 0)
10901 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
10902 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10903 }
10904 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10905 return;
10906 }
10907 }
10908
10909 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
10910 and precedences of the operators. */
10911
10912 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
10913 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
10914 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
10915 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
10916 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
10917 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
10918 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
10919 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
10920 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
10921 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10922 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10923 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10924 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10925 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
10926 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
10927 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
10928 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
10929 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
10930 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
10931 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
10932 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
10933 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
10934 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
10935 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
10936 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10937 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10938 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10939 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10940 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10941 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10942 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10943 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10944 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
10945 };
10946 \f
10947 enum ada_primitive_types {
10948 ada_primitive_type_int,
10949 ada_primitive_type_long,
10950 ada_primitive_type_short,
10951 ada_primitive_type_char,
10952 ada_primitive_type_float,
10953 ada_primitive_type_double,
10954 ada_primitive_type_void,
10955 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
10956 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
10957 ada_primitive_type_natural,
10958 ada_primitive_type_positive,
10959 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
10960 nr_ada_primitive_types
10961 };
10962
10963 static void
10964 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10965 struct language_arch_info *lai)
10966 {
10967 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
10968 lai->primitive_type_vector
10969 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
10970 struct type *);
10971 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int] =
10972 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10973 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10974 0, "integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10975 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long] =
10976 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10977 gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10978 0, "long_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10979 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short] =
10980 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10981 gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10982 0, "short_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10983 lai->string_char_type =
10984 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char] =
10985 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT, TARGET_CHAR_BIT / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10986 0, "character", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10987 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float] =
10988 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
10989 gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch)/ TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10990 0, "float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10991 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double] =
10992 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
10993 gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10994 0, "long_float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10995 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long] =
10996 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10997 gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10998 0, "long_long_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10999 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double] =
11000 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
11001 gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
11002 0, "long_long_float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
11003 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural] =
11004 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
11005 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
11006 0, "natural", (struct objfile *) NULL);
11007 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive] =
11008 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
11009 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
11010 0, "positive", (struct objfile *) NULL);
11011 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void] = builtin->builtin_void;
11012
11013 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address] =
11014 lookup_pointer_type (init_type (TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, 0, "void",
11015 (struct objfile *) NULL));
11016 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
11017 = "system__address";
11018
11019 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
11020 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
11021 }
11022 \f
11023 /* Language vector */
11024
11025 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
11026
11027 static void
11028 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
11029 {
11030 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
11031 }
11032
11033 static int
11034 parse (void)
11035 {
11036 warnings_issued = 0;
11037 return ada_parse ();
11038 }
11039
11040 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
11041 ada_print_subexp,
11042 ada_operator_length,
11043 ada_op_name,
11044 ada_dump_subexp_body,
11045 ada_evaluate_subexp
11046 };
11047
11048 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
11049 "ada", /* Language name */
11050 language_ada,
11051 range_check_off,
11052 type_check_off,
11053 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
11054 that's not quite what this means. */
11055 array_row_major,
11056 macro_expansion_no,
11057 &ada_exp_descriptor,
11058 parse,
11059 ada_error,
11060 resolve,
11061 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
11062 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
11063 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
11064 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
11065 default_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
11066 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
11067 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
11068 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
11069 NULL, /* name_of_this */
11070 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
11071 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
11072 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
11073 NULL, /* Language specific class_name_from_physname */
11074 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
11075 0, /* c-style arrays */
11076 1, /* String lower bound */
11077 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
11078 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
11079 ada_language_arch_info,
11080 ada_print_array_index,
11081 default_pass_by_reference,
11082 c_get_string,
11083 LANG_MAGIC
11084 };
11085
11086 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
11087 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
11088
11089 void
11090 _initialize_ada_language (void)
11091 {
11092 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
11093
11094 varsize_limit = 65536;
11095
11096 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
11097
11098 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
11099 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
11100 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
11101
11102 observer_attach_executable_changed (ada_executable_changed_observer);
11103 }
This page took 0.265055 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.